ido.el fix for bug#13036
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blob6199c2a436e3e7026d91f29e31a74873708411cb
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
277 #include "lisp.h"
278 #include "atimer.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
315 #include "font.h"
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
336 /* Cursor shapes. */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
339 /* Pointer shapes. */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
350 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_internal;
352 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
354 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
356 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
358 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
360 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
361 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
362 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
363 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
364 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
365 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
366 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
367 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
369 /* These setters are used only in this file, so they can be private. */
370 static void
371 wset_base_line_number (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
373 w->base_line_number = val;
375 static void
376 wset_base_line_pos (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
378 w->base_line_pos = val;
380 static void
381 wset_column_number_displayed (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
383 w->column_number_displayed = val;
385 static void
386 wset_region_showing (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
388 w->region_showing = val;
391 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
393 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
394 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
396 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
397 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
398 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
399 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
400 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
401 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
402 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
403 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
405 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
406 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
407 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
409 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
410 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
411 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
413 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
414 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
415 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
416 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
417 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
418 || (it->s \
419 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
420 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
421 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
422 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
423 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
425 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
427 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
429 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
431 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
433 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
435 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
437 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
438 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
440 Lisp_Object Qimage;
442 /* The image map types. */
443 Lisp_Object QCmap;
444 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
445 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
447 /* Tool bar styles */
448 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
450 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
451 message. */
453 int noninteractive_need_newline;
455 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
457 static int message_log_need_newline;
459 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
460 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
461 in handling memory-full errors. */
462 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
463 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
464 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
466 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
467 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
468 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
469 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
471 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
473 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
474 terminating newline. */
476 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
478 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
480 static int this_line_vpos;
481 static int this_line_y;
482 static int this_line_pixel_height;
484 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
485 negative if first character is partially visible. */
487 static int this_line_start_x;
489 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
490 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
491 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
493 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
495 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
497 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
500 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
501 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
502 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
503 numerical position. */
505 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
507 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
508 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
510 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
512 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
514 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
516 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
518 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected
519 window (or another buffer with the same base buffer). */
521 int buffer_shared;
523 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
525 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
527 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
528 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
529 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
531 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
533 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
534 pushes the current message and the value of
535 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
536 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
538 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
540 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
541 message was specified. */
543 static int message_enable_multibyte;
545 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
547 int update_mode_lines;
549 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
550 redisplay that finished. */
552 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
554 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
556 int cursor_type_changed;
558 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
559 line number. */
561 static int line_number_displayed;
563 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
565 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
567 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
568 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
570 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
572 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
574 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
576 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
578 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
580 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
581 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
583 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
585 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
586 message. */
588 static int message_buf_print;
590 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
592 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
593 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
595 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
596 of an emptied echo area. */
598 static int message_cleared_p;
600 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
601 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
603 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
604 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
605 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
607 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
609 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
611 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
613 int help_echo_showing_p;
615 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
616 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
617 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
619 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
621 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
622 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
623 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
624 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
625 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
627 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
629 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
630 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
631 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
632 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
633 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
634 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
635 return to the original iterator. */
636 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
637 do { \
638 if (CACHE) \
639 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
640 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
641 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
642 } while (0)
644 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
645 do { \
646 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
647 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
648 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
649 CACHE = NULL; \
650 } while (0)
652 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
654 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
655 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
657 int trace_redisplay_p;
659 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
661 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
662 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
663 int trace_move;
665 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
666 #else
667 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
668 #endif
670 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
672 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
674 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
676 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
678 enum prop_handled
680 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
681 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
682 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
683 HANDLED_RETURN
686 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
687 in. */
689 struct props
691 /* The name of the property. */
692 Lisp_Object *name;
694 /* A unique index for the property. */
695 enum prop_idx idx;
697 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
698 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
699 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
702 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
703 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
704 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
705 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
706 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
707 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
709 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
711 static struct props it_props[] =
713 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
714 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
715 `display' need to know the face. */
716 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
717 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
718 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
719 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
720 {NULL, 0, NULL}
723 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
724 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
726 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
728 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
730 enum move_it_result
732 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
733 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
735 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
736 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
738 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
739 MOVE_X_REACHED,
741 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
742 continued. */
743 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
745 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
746 be displayed truncated. */
747 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
749 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
750 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
753 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
754 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
755 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
756 cleared. */
758 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
759 static int clear_face_cache_count;
761 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
763 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
764 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
765 static int clear_image_cache_count;
767 /* Null glyph slice */
768 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
769 #endif
771 /* True while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
773 bool redisplaying_p;
775 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
776 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
778 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
779 (The display is done in read_char.) */
781 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
782 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
783 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
784 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
786 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
788 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
790 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
792 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
793 int hourglass_shown_p;
795 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
796 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
797 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
799 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
800 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
802 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
803 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
805 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
806 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
808 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
809 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
811 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
812 cursor. */
813 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
816 /* Function prototypes. */
818 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
819 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
820 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
821 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
822 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
823 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
824 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
825 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
827 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
829 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
831 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
832 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
833 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
834 struct text_pos);
835 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
836 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
837 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
838 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
839 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
840 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
841 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
842 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
843 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
844 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
845 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
846 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
847 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
848 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
849 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
850 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
851 static void pop_message (void);
852 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
853 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, int);
854 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
855 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
856 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
857 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
858 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
859 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
860 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
861 struct text_pos);
862 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
863 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
864 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
865 Lisp_Object);
866 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
867 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
868 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
869 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
870 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
871 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
872 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
873 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
874 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
875 static void pop_it (struct it *);
876 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
877 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
878 static void redisplay_internal (void);
879 static int echo_area_display (int);
880 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
881 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
882 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
883 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
884 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
885 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
886 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
887 int, int);
888 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
889 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
890 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
891 static int display_line (struct it *);
892 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
893 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
894 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
895 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
896 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
897 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
898 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
899 ptrdiff_t *);
900 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
901 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
902 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
903 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
904 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
905 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
906 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
907 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
908 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
909 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
910 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
911 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
912 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
913 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
914 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
915 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
916 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
917 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
918 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
919 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
920 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
921 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
922 struct display_pos *);
923 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
924 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
925 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
926 static enum move_it_result
927 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
928 enum move_operation_enum);
929 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
930 static void get_visually_first_element (struct it *);
931 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
932 struct glyph_row *);
933 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
934 struct glyph_row *);
935 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
936 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
937 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
938 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
939 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
940 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, int);
941 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, int);
942 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
943 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
944 Lisp_Object);
945 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
946 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
947 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
948 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
949 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
950 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
951 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
952 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
953 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
954 struct window *);
956 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
957 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
959 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
961 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
962 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
963 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
964 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
965 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
966 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
967 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
968 enum glyph_row_area,
969 int, int, int, int);
970 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
971 int, int, int);
974 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
976 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
977 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
978 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
982 /***********************************************************************
983 Window display dimensions
984 ***********************************************************************/
986 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
987 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
988 It is relative to the top of the window.
990 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
993 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
995 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
997 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
998 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
999 return height;
1002 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
1003 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
1004 the left and right of the window. */
1007 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
1009 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
1010 int pixels = 0;
1012 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1014 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
1016 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1018 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
1019 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
1020 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
1021 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
1022 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1024 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1026 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
1027 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
1028 pixels = 0;
1030 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1032 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
1033 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
1034 pixels = 0;
1038 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1042 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1043 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1046 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1048 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1049 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1051 eassert (height >= 0);
1053 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1054 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1055 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1056 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1057 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1059 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1061 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1062 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1063 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1064 : 0);
1065 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1066 height -= ml_row->height;
1067 else
1068 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1071 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1073 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1074 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1075 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1076 : 0);
1077 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1078 height -= hl_row->height;
1079 else
1080 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1083 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1084 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1085 return max (0, height);
1088 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1089 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1090 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1093 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1095 int x;
1097 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1098 return 0;
1100 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1102 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1103 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1104 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1105 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1106 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1107 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1108 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1109 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1111 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1112 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1113 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1114 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1116 return x;
1120 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1121 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1122 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1125 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1127 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1130 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1131 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1132 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1135 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1137 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1138 int x;
1140 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1141 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1143 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1144 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1146 return x;
1150 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1151 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1152 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1155 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1157 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1160 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1161 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1162 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1163 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1164 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1165 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1167 void
1168 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1169 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1171 if (box_width)
1172 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1173 if (box_height)
1174 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1175 if (box_x)
1176 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1177 if (box_y)
1179 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1180 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1181 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1186 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1187 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1188 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1189 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1190 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1191 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1192 box. */
1194 static void
1195 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1196 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1198 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1199 bottom_right_y);
1200 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1201 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1206 /***********************************************************************
1207 Utilities
1208 ***********************************************************************/
1210 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1211 This can modify IT's settings. */
1214 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1216 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1217 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1219 if (line_height == 0)
1221 if (last_height)
1222 line_height = last_height;
1223 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1225 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1226 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1227 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1228 : last_height);
1230 else
1232 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1234 /* Use the default character height. */
1235 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1236 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1237 it->c = ' ';
1238 it->len = 1;
1239 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1240 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1241 it->glyph_row = row;
1245 return line_top_y + line_height;
1248 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1249 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1250 static Lisp_Object
1251 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1253 if (CONSP (spec))
1255 while (CONSP (spec))
1257 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1258 return XCAR (spec);
1259 spec = XCDR (spec);
1262 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1264 ptrdiff_t i;
1266 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1268 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1269 return AREF (spec, i);
1271 return Qnil;
1274 return spec;
1278 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1279 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1280 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1281 static int
1282 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1284 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1285 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1286 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1288 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1289 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1291 return window_hscroll;
1294 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1295 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1296 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1297 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1298 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1301 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1302 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1304 struct it it;
1305 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1306 struct text_pos top;
1307 int visible_p = 0;
1308 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1310 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1311 return visible_p;
1313 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1315 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1316 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1319 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1320 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1321 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1322 our backs. */
1323 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1324 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1326 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1327 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1328 current_mode_line_height
1329 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1330 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1332 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1333 current_header_line_height
1334 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1335 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1337 start_display (&it, w, top);
1338 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1339 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1341 if (charpos >= 0
1342 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1343 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1344 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1345 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1346 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1347 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1348 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1350 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1351 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1352 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1353 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1354 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1355 glyph. */
1356 int top_x = it.current_x;
1357 int top_y = it.current_y;
1358 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1359 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1360 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1361 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1363 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1364 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1365 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1366 visible_p = 1;
1367 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1368 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1369 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1371 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1372 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1373 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1374 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1375 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1376 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1377 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1378 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1379 struct it save_it = it;
1380 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1381 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1382 int ten_more_lines =
1383 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)));
1385 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1386 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1387 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1388 visible_p = 0;
1390 it = save_it;
1392 if (visible_p)
1394 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1396 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1397 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1398 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1399 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1400 else
1402 struct it it2;
1403 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1404 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1405 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1406 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1407 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1408 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1409 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1410 else
1412 top_x = it2.current_x;
1413 top_y = it2.current_y;
1417 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1419 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1420 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1421 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1422 int newline_in_string = 0;
1424 if (STRINGP (string))
1426 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1427 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1428 while (s < e)
1430 if (*s++ == '\n')
1432 newline_in_string = 1;
1433 break;
1437 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1438 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1439 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1440 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1441 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1442 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1443 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1445 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1446 display property whose value is a string. If the
1447 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1448 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1449 where the display string begins. */
1450 if (newline_in_string)
1452 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1453 EMACS_INT start, end;
1454 struct it it3;
1455 int it3_moved;
1457 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1458 covered by the display string. */
1459 endpos =
1460 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1461 Qnil, Qnil);
1462 startpos =
1463 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1464 Qnil, Qnil);
1465 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1466 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1467 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1468 display property. */
1469 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1470 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1471 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1472 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1473 rightmost character on a line that is
1474 continued or word-wrapped. */
1475 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1476 && it3.c == '\n')
1477 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1478 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1479 it3.current_x
1480 + it3.pixel_width,
1481 MOVE_TO_X)
1482 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1484 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1485 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1486 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1487 fix that up. */
1488 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1489 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1492 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1493 line where we wound up. */
1494 top_y = it3.current_y;
1495 if (it3.bidi_p)
1497 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1498 the character displayed to the left of the
1499 display string could be _after_ the display
1500 property in the logical order. Use the
1501 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1502 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1503 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1504 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1505 top_y = it3.current_y;
1507 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1508 of the display line where the display string
1509 begins. */
1510 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1511 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1512 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1513 below, that means we already were at a newline
1514 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1515 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1516 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1517 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1518 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1519 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1520 it3_moved = 0;
1521 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1522 first display element whose character position is
1523 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1524 display string, which signals the end of the
1525 display line. */
1526 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1528 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1529 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1530 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1531 break;
1532 it3_moved = 1;
1533 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1535 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1536 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1537 found the display element whose character
1538 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1539 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1540 display string, move back over the glyphs
1541 produced from the string, until we find the
1542 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1543 if (it3_moved
1544 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1546 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1547 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1549 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1551 --g;
1552 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1554 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1555 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1560 *x = top_x;
1561 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1562 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1563 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1564 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1565 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1566 *vpos = it.vpos;
1569 else
1571 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1572 struct it it2;
1573 void *it2data = NULL;
1575 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1576 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1577 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1578 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1579 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1581 visible_p = 1;
1582 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1583 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1584 *x = it2.current_x;
1585 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1586 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1587 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1588 - it.last_visible_y));
1589 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1590 it.last_visible_y)
1591 - max (it2.current_y,
1592 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1593 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1595 else
1596 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1598 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1600 if (old_buffer)
1601 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1603 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1605 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1606 *x -=
1607 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1608 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1610 #if 0
1611 /* Debugging code. */
1612 if (visible_p)
1613 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1614 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1615 else
1616 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1617 #endif
1619 return visible_p;
1623 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1624 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1625 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1626 with the length of the invalid character. */
1628 static int
1629 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1631 int c;
1633 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1634 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1635 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1636 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1637 characters. */
1638 c = '?';
1640 return c;
1645 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1646 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1648 static struct text_pos
1649 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1651 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1653 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1655 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1656 int len;
1658 while (nchars--)
1660 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1661 p += len;
1662 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1663 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1666 else
1667 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1669 return pos;
1673 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1674 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1676 static struct text_pos
1677 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1679 struct text_pos pos;
1680 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1681 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1682 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1683 return pos;
1687 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1688 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1689 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1691 static struct text_pos
1692 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1694 struct text_pos pos;
1696 eassert (s != NULL);
1697 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1699 if (multibyte_p)
1701 int len;
1703 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1704 while (charpos--)
1706 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1707 s += len;
1708 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1709 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1712 else
1713 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1715 return pos;
1719 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1720 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1722 static ptrdiff_t
1723 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1725 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1727 if (multibyte_p)
1729 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1730 int len;
1731 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1733 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1735 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1736 rest -= len, p += len;
1739 else
1740 nchars = strlen (s);
1742 return nchars;
1746 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1747 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1748 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1750 static void
1751 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1753 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1754 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1756 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1757 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1758 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1759 else
1760 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1763 /* EXPORT:
1764 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1765 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1768 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1770 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1771 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1773 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1775 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1776 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1777 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1779 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1780 if (face)
1782 if (face->font)
1783 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1784 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1785 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1789 return height;
1791 #endif
1793 return 1;
1796 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1797 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1798 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1799 not force the value into range. */
1801 void
1802 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1803 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1806 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1807 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1809 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1810 even for negative values. */
1811 if (pix_x < 0)
1812 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1813 if (pix_y < 0)
1814 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1816 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1817 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1819 if (bounds)
1820 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1821 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1822 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1823 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1824 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1826 if (!noclip)
1828 if (pix_x < 0)
1829 pix_x = 0;
1830 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1831 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1833 if (pix_y < 0)
1834 pix_y = 0;
1835 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1836 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1839 #endif
1841 *x = pix_x;
1842 *y = pix_y;
1846 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1847 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1848 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1849 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1850 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1851 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1852 date. */
1854 static
1855 struct glyph *
1856 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1857 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1859 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1860 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1861 int x0, i;
1863 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1864 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1866 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1867 if (!row->enabled_p)
1868 return NULL;
1869 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1870 break;
1873 *vpos = i;
1874 *hpos = 0;
1876 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1877 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1878 return NULL;
1880 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1881 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1883 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1884 x0 = 0;
1886 else
1888 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1890 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1891 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1893 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1895 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1896 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1898 else
1900 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1901 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1905 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1906 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1907 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1908 x -= x0;
1909 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1911 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1912 ++glyph;
1915 if (glyph == end)
1916 return NULL;
1918 if (dx)
1920 *dx = x;
1921 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1924 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1925 return glyph;
1928 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1929 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1931 static void
1932 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1934 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1936 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1937 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1938 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1939 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1940 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1942 else
1944 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1945 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1949 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1951 /* EXPORT:
1952 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1953 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1956 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1958 XRectangle r;
1960 if (n <= 0)
1961 return 0;
1963 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1965 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1966 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1967 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1969 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1970 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1971 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1972 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1973 else
1974 r.height = s->height;
1976 else
1978 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1979 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1980 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1981 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1984 if (s->clip_head)
1985 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1987 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1988 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1989 else
1990 r.width = 0;
1991 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1993 if (s->clip_tail)
1994 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1996 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1997 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1998 else
1999 r.width = 0;
2002 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2003 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2004 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2005 if (s->for_overlaps)
2007 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2008 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2010 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2011 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2012 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2013 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2014 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2015 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2017 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2019 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2020 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2021 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2022 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2024 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2027 else
2029 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2030 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2031 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2032 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2033 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2034 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2035 else
2036 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2039 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2041 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2042 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2043 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2045 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2046 int height, max_y;
2048 if (s->x > r.x)
2050 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2051 r.x = s->x;
2053 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2055 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2056 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2057 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2058 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2059 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2060 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2062 r.y = max_y;
2063 r.height = height;
2065 else
2067 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2068 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2069 if (height < r.height)
2071 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2072 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2073 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2078 if (s->row->clip)
2080 XRectangle r_save = r;
2082 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2083 r.width = 0;
2086 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2087 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2089 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2090 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2091 #else
2092 *rects = r;
2093 #endif
2094 return 1;
2096 else
2098 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2099 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2100 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2101 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2102 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2103 XRectangle rs[2];
2104 #else
2105 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2106 #endif
2107 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2109 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2111 rs[i] = r;
2112 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2114 if (r.y < row_y)
2115 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2116 else
2117 rs[i].height = 0;
2119 i++;
2121 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2123 rs[i] = r;
2124 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2126 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2128 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2129 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2131 else
2132 rs[i].height = 0;
2134 i++;
2137 n = i;
2138 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2139 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2140 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2141 #endif
2142 return n;
2146 /* EXPORT:
2147 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2149 void
2150 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2152 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2156 /* EXPORT:
2157 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2158 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2161 void
2162 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2163 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2165 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2166 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2168 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2169 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2170 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2171 width instead. */
2172 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2173 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2174 wd++; /* Why? */
2175 #endif
2177 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2178 if (x < 0)
2180 wd += x;
2181 x = 0;
2184 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2185 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2186 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2187 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2189 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2191 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2192 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2194 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2195 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2197 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2198 if (y < y0)
2200 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2201 y = y0 - 1;
2203 else
2205 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2206 if (y > y0)
2208 h += y - y0;
2209 y = y0;
2213 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2214 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2215 *heightp = h;
2219 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2222 void
2223 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2225 Lisp_Object window;
2226 struct window *w;
2227 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2228 enum window_part part;
2229 enum glyph_row_area area;
2230 int x, y, width, height;
2232 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2233 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2235 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2236 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2237 NILP (window)))
2239 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2240 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2241 goto virtual_glyph;
2244 w = XWINDOW (window);
2245 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2246 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2248 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2249 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2251 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2252 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2254 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2256 area = TEXT_AREA;
2257 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2258 goto text_glyph;
2261 switch (part)
2263 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2264 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2265 goto text_glyph;
2267 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2268 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2269 goto text_glyph;
2271 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2272 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2273 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2274 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2275 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2276 gy = gr->y;
2277 area = TEXT_AREA;
2278 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2280 case ON_TEXT:
2281 area = TEXT_AREA;
2283 text_glyph:
2284 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2285 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2286 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2288 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2289 break;
2292 text_glyph_row_found:
2293 if (gr && gy <= y)
2295 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2296 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2298 height = gr->height;
2299 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2300 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2301 break;
2303 if (g < end)
2305 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2307 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2308 image may have hot-spots. */
2309 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2310 return;
2312 width = g->pixel_width;
2314 else
2316 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2317 x -= gx;
2318 gx += (x / width) * width;
2321 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2322 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2324 else
2326 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2327 gx = (x / width) * width;
2328 y -= gy;
2329 gy += (y / height) * height;
2331 break;
2333 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2334 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2335 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2336 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2337 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2338 goto row_glyph;
2340 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2341 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2342 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2343 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2344 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2345 goto row_glyph;
2347 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2348 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2350 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2351 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2352 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2353 : 0)));
2354 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2356 row_glyph:
2357 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2358 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2359 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2361 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2362 break;
2365 if (gr && gy <= y)
2366 height = gr->height;
2367 else
2369 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2370 y -= gy;
2371 gy += (y / height) * height;
2373 break;
2375 default:
2377 virtual_glyph:
2378 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2379 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2380 as our "glyph". */
2382 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2383 round down even for negative values. */
2384 if (gx < 0)
2385 gx -= width - 1;
2386 if (gy < 0)
2387 gy -= height - 1;
2389 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2390 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2392 goto store_rect;
2395 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2396 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2398 store_rect:
2399 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2401 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2402 #if 0
2403 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2404 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2405 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2406 gx, gy, width, height);
2407 #endif
2408 #endif
2412 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2415 /***********************************************************************
2416 Lisp form evaluation
2417 ***********************************************************************/
2419 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2421 static Lisp_Object
2422 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2424 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signaled %S",
2425 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2426 return Qnil;
2429 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2430 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2431 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2433 Lisp_Object
2434 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2436 Lisp_Object val;
2438 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2439 val = Qnil;
2440 else
2442 va_list ap;
2443 ptrdiff_t i;
2444 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2445 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2446 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2448 args[0] = func;
2449 va_start (ap, func);
2450 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2451 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2452 va_end (ap);
2454 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2455 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2456 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2457 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2458 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2459 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2460 safe_eval_handler);
2461 UNGCPRO;
2462 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2465 return val;
2469 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2470 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2472 Lisp_Object
2473 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2475 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2478 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2480 Lisp_Object
2481 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2483 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2486 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2487 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2489 Lisp_Object
2490 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2492 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2497 /***********************************************************************
2498 Debugging
2499 ***********************************************************************/
2501 #if 0
2503 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2504 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2506 static void
2507 check_it (struct it *it)
2509 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2511 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2512 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2514 else
2516 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2517 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2519 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2520 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2524 if (it->dpvec)
2525 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2526 else
2527 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2530 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2532 #else /* not 0 */
2534 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2536 #endif /* not 0 */
2539 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2541 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2542 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2544 static void
2545 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2547 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2548 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2550 struct glyph_row *row;
2551 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2552 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2553 !row->enabled_p
2554 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2555 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2559 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2561 #else
2563 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2565 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2569 /***********************************************************************
2570 Iterator initialization
2571 ***********************************************************************/
2573 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2574 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2575 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2576 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2577 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2579 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2580 will produce glyphs in that row.
2582 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2583 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2584 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2585 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2587 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2588 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2589 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2590 the desired matrix of W. */
2592 void
2593 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2594 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2595 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2597 int highlight_region_p;
2598 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2600 /* Some precondition checks. */
2601 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2602 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2603 && charpos <= ZV));
2605 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2606 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2607 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2608 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2609 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2611 face_change_count = 0;
2612 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2615 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2616 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2617 remapped_base_face_id
2618 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2620 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2621 appropriate. */
2622 if (row == NULL)
2624 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2625 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2626 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2627 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2628 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2631 /* Clear IT. */
2632 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2633 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2634 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2635 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2636 it->string = Qnil;
2637 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2638 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2639 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2640 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2641 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2643 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2644 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2645 it->w = w;
2646 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2648 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2650 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2651 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2652 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2654 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2655 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2656 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2657 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2658 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2659 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2660 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2661 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2664 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2665 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2666 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2667 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2668 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2669 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2670 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2671 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2673 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2674 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2675 it->space_width = Qnil;
2676 it->font_height = Qnil;
2677 it->override_ascent = -1;
2679 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2680 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2682 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2683 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2684 invisible. */
2685 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2686 ? (clip_to_bounds
2687 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2688 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2689 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2690 ? -1 : 0));
2691 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2692 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2694 /* Display table to use. */
2695 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2697 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2698 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2700 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2701 highlight_region_p
2702 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2703 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2704 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2706 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2707 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2708 -1 to indicate no region. */
2709 if (highlight_region_p
2710 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2711 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2712 highlight_nonselected_windows
2713 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2714 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2715 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2716 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2717 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2718 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2719 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2721 ptrdiff_t markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2722 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2723 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2725 else
2726 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2728 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2729 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2730 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2731 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2732 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2733 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2734 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2735 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2736 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2738 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2740 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2741 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2742 || it->w->hscroll
2743 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2744 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2745 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2746 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2747 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2748 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2749 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2750 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2751 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2752 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2753 else
2754 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2756 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2757 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2758 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2759 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2760 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2761 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2762 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2763 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2764 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2765 #endif
2767 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2769 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2770 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2771 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2772 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2774 else
2776 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2777 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2778 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2779 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2783 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2784 above has changed them. */
2785 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2786 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2788 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2789 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2790 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2791 it->glyph_row = row;
2792 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2794 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2795 if (it->glyph_row)
2796 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2798 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2799 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2800 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2801 start of this total display area. */
2802 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2804 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2805 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2806 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2808 else
2810 it->first_visible_x =
2811 window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2812 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2813 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2815 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2816 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2817 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2818 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2819 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2820 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2821 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2822 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2824 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2825 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2826 else
2827 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2830 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2831 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2834 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2835 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2836 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2837 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2839 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2841 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2842 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2843 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2845 struct face *face;
2847 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2849 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2850 with a left box line. */
2851 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2852 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2853 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2856 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2857 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2858 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2860 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2861 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2863 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2864 handle_face_prop. */
2865 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2867 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2868 if (bytepos < charpos)
2869 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2870 else
2871 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2873 it->start = it->current;
2874 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2875 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2876 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2877 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2878 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2879 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2880 available. */
2881 it->bidi_p =
2882 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2883 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2884 && it->multibyte_p;
2886 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2887 iterator. */
2888 if (it->bidi_p)
2890 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2891 use. */
2892 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2893 Qleft_to_right))
2894 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2895 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2896 Qright_to_left))
2897 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2898 else
2899 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2900 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2901 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2902 &it->bidi_it);
2905 /* Compute faces etc. */
2906 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2909 CHECK_IT (it);
2913 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2915 void
2916 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2918 struct glyph_row *row;
2919 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2921 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2922 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2923 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2925 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2926 position is in a string or image. */
2927 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2929 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2930 int first_y = it->current_y;
2932 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2933 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2934 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2935 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2936 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2938 int new_x;
2940 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2941 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2943 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2945 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2946 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2947 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2948 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2949 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2950 end of the continued line. */
2951 if (it->current_x > 0
2952 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2953 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2954 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2955 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2956 system frame. */
2957 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2958 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2959 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
2960 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
2961 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
2963 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2964 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2965 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
2966 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
2967 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
2968 that case, as this line is not really continued.
2969 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
2970 && it->c != '\n')
2972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2973 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2976 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2978 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
2979 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
2980 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
2981 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
2982 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
2983 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
2984 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
2986 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2987 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2988 fields in the iterator structure. */
2989 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2990 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2992 it->current_y = first_y;
2993 it->vpos = 0;
2994 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
3000 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3001 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3003 static int
3004 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3006 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3007 int ellipses_p = 0;
3008 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3010 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3011 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3012 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3013 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3014 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3015 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3016 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3017 && charpos > BEGV
3018 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3019 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3020 Qinvisible, window),
3021 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3023 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3024 window);
3025 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3028 return ellipses_p;
3032 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3033 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3034 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3035 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3037 static int
3038 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3040 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3041 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3043 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3044 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3045 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3046 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3047 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3049 --charpos;
3050 bytepos = 0;
3053 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3054 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3055 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3056 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3057 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3058 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3059 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3060 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3061 after-string. */
3062 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3064 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3065 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3066 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3067 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3069 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3070 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3072 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3073 ++s;
3075 if (s < e)
3077 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3078 break;
3082 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3083 overlay string. */
3084 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3086 int relative_index;
3088 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3089 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3090 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3091 correct the overlay string index. */
3092 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3093 pop_it (it);
3095 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3096 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3097 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3098 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3100 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3101 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3102 while (n--)
3104 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3105 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3109 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3110 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3111 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3112 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3113 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3114 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3115 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3116 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
3117 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
3118 if (it->bidi_p)
3120 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
3121 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
3122 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
3123 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
3124 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
3125 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
3126 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3127 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3129 /* Synchronize the state of the bidi iterator with
3130 pos->string_pos. For any string position other than
3131 zero, this will be done automagically when we resume
3132 iteration over the string and get_visually_first_element
3133 is called. But if string_pos is zero, and the string is
3134 to be reordered for display, we need to resync manually,
3135 since it could be that the iteration state recorded in
3136 pos ended at string_pos of 0 moving backwards in string. */
3137 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) == 0)
3139 get_visually_first_element (it);
3140 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) != 0)
3141 do {
3142 /* Paranoia. */
3143 eassert (it->bidi_it.charpos < it->bidi_it.string.schars);
3144 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
3145 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != 0);
3147 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
3148 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos);
3152 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3154 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3155 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3156 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3157 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3158 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3159 if (it->bidi_p)
3160 bidi_init_it (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
3161 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
3164 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3165 character translations or ellipses. */
3166 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3168 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3169 get_next_display_element (it);
3170 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3171 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3174 CHECK_IT (it);
3175 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3179 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3180 starting at ROW->start. */
3182 static void
3183 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3185 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3186 it->start = row->start;
3187 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3188 CHECK_IT (it);
3192 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3193 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3194 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3195 end position. */
3197 static int
3198 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3200 int success = 0;
3202 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3204 if (row->continued_p)
3205 it->continuation_lines_width
3206 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3207 CHECK_IT (it);
3208 success = 1;
3211 return success;
3217 /***********************************************************************
3218 Text properties
3219 ***********************************************************************/
3221 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3222 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3223 to stop. */
3225 static void
3226 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3228 enum prop_handled handled;
3229 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3230 struct props *p;
3232 it->dpvec = NULL;
3233 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3234 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3235 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3236 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3238 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3239 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3240 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3244 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3246 /* Call text property handlers. */
3247 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3249 handled = p->handler (it);
3251 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3252 break;
3253 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3255 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3256 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3257 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3258 || it->sp > 1
3259 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3260 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3261 will load them again and push the iterator state
3262 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3263 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3264 overlay strings. */
3265 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3266 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3267 : 0))
3269 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3270 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3271 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3272 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3273 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3274 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3275 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3276 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3277 pop_it (it);
3278 return;
3280 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3281 pop_it (it);
3282 else
3284 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3285 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3286 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3287 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3289 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3290 break;
3292 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3293 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3296 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3298 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3299 characters from a display vector. */
3300 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3301 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3303 /* Handle overlay changes.
3304 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3305 if it finds overlays. */
3306 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3307 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3310 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3312 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3313 break;
3316 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3318 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3319 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3320 compute_stop_pos (it);
3324 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3325 information for IT's current position. */
3327 static void
3328 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3330 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3331 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3332 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3334 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3336 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3337 properties. */
3338 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3339 object = it->string;
3340 limit = Qnil;
3341 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3342 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3344 else
3346 ptrdiff_t pos;
3348 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3349 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3350 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3351 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3352 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3354 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3355 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3356 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3357 follows. */
3358 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3359 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3360 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3361 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3362 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3364 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3365 start or end because the face might change there. */
3366 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3368 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3369 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3370 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3371 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3374 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3375 property changes. */
3376 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3377 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3380 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3381 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3382 position = make_number (charpos);
3383 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3384 if (iv)
3386 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3387 struct props *p;
3389 /* Get properties here. */
3390 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3391 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3393 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3394 properties. */
3395 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3396 (next_iv
3397 && (NILP (limit)
3398 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3399 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3401 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3403 Lisp_Object new_value;
3405 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3406 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3407 break;
3410 if (p->handler)
3411 break;
3414 if (next_iv)
3416 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3417 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3418 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3419 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3420 else
3421 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3422 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3426 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3428 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3430 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3431 stoppos = -1;
3432 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3433 stoppos, it->string);
3436 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3437 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3438 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3442 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3443 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3444 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3445 xmalloc. */
3447 static ptrdiff_t
3448 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3450 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3451 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3452 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3454 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3455 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3457 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3458 use its ending point instead. */
3459 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3461 Lisp_Object oend;
3462 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3464 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3465 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3466 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3469 return endpos;
3472 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3473 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3474 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3475 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3477 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3478 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3479 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3480 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3481 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3482 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3483 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3484 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3485 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3486 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3487 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3488 white space in the text area. */
3489 ptrdiff_t
3490 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3491 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3492 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3494 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3495 Lisp_Object object =
3496 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3497 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3498 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3499 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3500 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3501 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3502 ptrdiff_t lim =
3503 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3504 struct text_pos tpos;
3505 int rv = 0;
3507 *disp_prop = 1;
3509 if (charpos >= eob
3510 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3511 that have display string properties. */
3512 || string->from_disp_str
3513 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3514 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3516 *disp_prop = 0;
3517 return eob;
3520 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3521 return CHARPOS. */
3522 pos = make_number (charpos);
3523 if (STRINGP (object))
3524 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3525 else
3526 bufpos = charpos;
3527 tpos = *position;
3528 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3529 && (charpos <= begb
3530 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3531 object),
3532 spec))
3533 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3534 frame_window_p)))
3536 if (rv == 2)
3537 *disp_prop = 2;
3538 return charpos;
3541 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3542 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3543 limpos = make_number (lim);
3544 do {
3545 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3546 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3547 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3549 *disp_prop = 0;
3550 break;
3552 if (STRINGP (object))
3553 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3554 else
3555 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3556 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3557 if (!STRINGP (object))
3558 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3559 } while (NILP (spec)
3560 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3561 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3562 if (rv == 2)
3563 *disp_prop = 2;
3565 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3568 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3569 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3570 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3571 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3572 value is a string. */
3573 ptrdiff_t
3574 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3576 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3577 Lisp_Object object =
3578 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3579 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3580 ptrdiff_t eob =
3581 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3583 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3584 return eob;
3586 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3587 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3588 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3589 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3590 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3591 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3592 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3593 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3594 how this is handled.
3596 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3597 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3598 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3599 stop_charpos is. */
3600 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3601 return -1;
3603 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3604 changes. */
3605 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3607 return XFASTINT (pos);
3612 /***********************************************************************
3613 Fontification
3614 ***********************************************************************/
3616 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3617 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3618 regions of text. */
3620 static enum prop_handled
3621 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3623 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3624 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3626 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3627 return handled;
3629 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3630 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3631 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3632 Qfontification_functions. */
3633 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3634 && it->s == NULL
3635 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3636 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3637 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3638 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3639 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3640 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3641 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3643 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3644 Lisp_Object val;
3645 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3646 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3647 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3649 val = Vfontification_functions;
3650 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3652 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3654 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3655 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3656 else
3658 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3659 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3661 fns = Qnil;
3662 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3664 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3666 fn = XCAR (val);
3668 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3670 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3671 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3672 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3673 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3674 loop. */
3675 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3676 CONSP (fns);
3677 fns = XCDR (fns))
3679 fn = XCAR (fns);
3680 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3681 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3684 else
3685 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3688 UNGCPRO;
3691 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3693 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3694 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3695 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3696 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3697 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3698 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3699 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3700 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3702 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3703 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3705 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3706 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3707 else if (BUFFER_LIVE_P (obuf))
3708 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3710 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3711 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3712 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3713 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3714 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3715 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3717 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3718 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3719 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3720 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3721 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3724 return handled;
3729 /***********************************************************************
3730 Faces
3731 ***********************************************************************/
3733 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3734 Called from handle_stop. */
3736 static enum prop_handled
3737 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3739 int new_face_id;
3740 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3742 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3744 new_face_id
3745 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3746 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3747 it->region_beg_charpos,
3748 it->region_end_charpos,
3749 &next_stop,
3750 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3751 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3752 0, it->base_face_id);
3754 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3755 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3756 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3757 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3758 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3759 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3760 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3762 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3764 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3765 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3766 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3767 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3768 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3769 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3770 it->start_of_box_run_p
3771 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3772 && (it->face_id >= 0
3773 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3774 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3775 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3778 else
3780 int base_face_id;
3781 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3782 int i;
3783 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3784 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3785 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3786 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3787 : Qnil);
3789 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3790 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3791 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3792 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3794 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3795 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3796 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3798 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3799 from_overlay
3800 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3801 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3802 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3803 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3805 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3806 break;
3809 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3811 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3812 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3813 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3814 base_face_id
3815 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3816 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3817 it->region_beg_charpos,
3818 it->region_end_charpos,
3819 &next_stop,
3820 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3821 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3823 from_overlay);
3825 else
3827 bufpos = 0;
3829 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3830 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3831 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3832 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3833 faces. */
3834 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3835 ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
3836 : underlying_face_id (it);
3839 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3840 it->string,
3841 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3842 bufpos,
3843 it->region_beg_charpos,
3844 it->region_end_charpos,
3845 &next_stop,
3846 base_face_id, 0);
3848 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3849 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3850 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3851 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3852 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3853 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3854 is really the end. */
3855 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3857 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3858 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3860 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3861 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3862 shadow on the left side. */
3863 it->start_of_box_run_p
3864 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3865 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3869 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3870 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3874 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3875 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3876 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3877 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3879 static int
3880 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3882 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3884 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3886 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3887 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3888 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3890 return face_id;
3894 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3895 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3896 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3897 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3899 static int
3900 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3902 int face_id, limit;
3903 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3904 struct it it_copy;
3905 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3907 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3909 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3911 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3912 int base_face_id;
3914 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3915 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3916 string start. */
3917 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3918 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3919 return it->face_id;
3921 if (!it->bidi_p)
3923 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3924 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3925 case is the same as the visual order. */
3926 if (before_p)
3927 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3928 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3929 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3930 composition. */
3931 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3932 else
3933 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3935 else
3937 if (before_p)
3939 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3940 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3941 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3942 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3943 family of functions. */
3944 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3945 character on this display line. */
3946 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3947 return it->face_id;
3948 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3949 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3950 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3951 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3952 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3953 cases here. */
3954 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3955 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3956 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3957 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3959 else
3961 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3962 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3963 order. */
3964 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3966 it_copy = *it;
3967 while (n--)
3968 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3970 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3973 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3975 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3976 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3977 else
3978 bufpos = 0;
3980 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3982 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3983 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3984 it->string,
3985 charpos,
3986 bufpos,
3987 it->region_beg_charpos,
3988 it->region_end_charpos,
3989 &next_check_charpos,
3990 base_face_id, 0);
3992 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3993 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3994 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3995 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3997 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3998 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
3999 int c, len;
4000 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4002 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
4003 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
4006 else
4008 struct text_pos pos;
4010 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
4011 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
4012 return it->face_id;
4014 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
4015 pos = it->current.pos;
4017 if (!it->bidi_p)
4019 if (before_p)
4020 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4021 else
4023 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
4025 /* For composition, we must check the position after
4026 the composition. */
4027 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
4028 pos.bytepos += it->len;
4030 else
4031 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
4034 else
4036 if (before_p)
4038 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4039 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4040 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4041 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4042 family of functions. */
4043 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4044 character on this display line. */
4045 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4046 return it->face_id;
4047 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4048 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4049 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4050 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4051 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4052 cases here. */
4053 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4054 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4055 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4056 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4058 else
4060 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4061 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4062 order. */
4063 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4065 it_copy = *it;
4066 while (n--)
4067 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4069 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4070 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4073 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4075 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4076 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4077 CHARPOS (pos),
4078 it->region_beg_charpos,
4079 it->region_end_charpos,
4080 &next_check_charpos,
4081 limit, 0, -1);
4083 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4084 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4085 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4086 if (it->multibyte_p)
4088 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4089 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4090 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4094 return face_id;
4099 /***********************************************************************
4100 Invisible text
4101 ***********************************************************************/
4103 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4104 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4106 static enum prop_handled
4107 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4109 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4110 int invis_p;
4111 Lisp_Object prop;
4113 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4115 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4117 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4118 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4119 property. */
4120 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4121 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4122 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4124 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4126 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4127 invisible text. */
4128 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4129 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4131 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4133 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4134 found in IT->string, if any. */
4135 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4136 XSETINT (limit, len);
4139 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4140 it->string, limit);
4141 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4143 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4144 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4145 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4146 if (invis_p == 2)
4147 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4150 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4152 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4153 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4155 if (endpos < len)
4157 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4158 struct text_pos old;
4159 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4161 old = it->current.string_pos;
4162 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4163 if (it->bidi_p)
4165 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4166 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4167 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4168 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4169 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4172 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4174 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4175 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4177 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4178 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4179 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4180 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4182 else
4184 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4185 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4188 else
4190 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4191 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4192 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4193 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4194 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4196 next_overlay_string (it);
4197 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4198 finished processing them. */
4199 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4201 else
4203 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4204 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4209 else
4211 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4212 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4214 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4215 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4216 pos = make_number (tem);
4217 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4218 &overlay);
4219 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4221 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4222 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4224 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4225 invisible text. */
4226 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4228 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4230 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4231 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4234 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4235 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4236 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4237 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4238 invisible property. */
4239 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4241 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4242 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4243 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4244 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4245 invis_p = 0;
4246 else
4248 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4249 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4250 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4251 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4252 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4253 newpos is visible. */
4254 pos = make_number (newpos);
4255 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4256 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4259 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4260 skip starting with next_stop. */
4261 if (invis_p)
4262 tem = next_stop;
4264 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4265 second one's ellipsis. */
4266 if (invis_p == 2)
4267 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4269 while (invis_p);
4271 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4272 if (it->bidi_p)
4274 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4275 int on_newline =
4276 bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4277 int after_newline =
4278 newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4280 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4281 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4282 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4283 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4284 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4285 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4286 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4287 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4289 struct text_pos tpos;
4290 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4292 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4293 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4294 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4295 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4296 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4297 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4298 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4299 if (on_newline)
4301 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4302 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4303 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4304 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4305 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4308 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4310 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4311 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4312 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4313 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4314 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4315 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4316 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4317 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4318 displayed text when invisible properties are
4319 added or removed. */
4320 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4322 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4323 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4324 need to do it now because
4325 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4326 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4327 text at the beginning, which resets the
4328 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4329 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4330 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4334 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4336 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4337 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4338 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4339 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4340 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4341 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4342 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4343 invisible region again. */
4344 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4345 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4348 else
4350 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4351 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4354 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4355 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4356 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4357 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4358 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4359 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4360 if (NILP (overlay)
4361 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4363 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4364 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4366 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4368 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4369 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4370 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4371 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4372 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4374 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4375 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4376 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4377 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4378 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4379 first invisible character. */
4380 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4382 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4383 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4385 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4386 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4387 considering any properties of the following char.
4388 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4389 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4394 return handled;
4398 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4399 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4401 static void
4402 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4404 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4405 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4406 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4408 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4409 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4410 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4412 else
4414 /* Default `...'. */
4415 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4416 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4419 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4420 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4421 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4423 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4424 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4425 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4426 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4427 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4429 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4430 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4435 /***********************************************************************
4436 'display' property
4437 ***********************************************************************/
4439 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4440 Called from handle_stop.
4441 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4442 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4443 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4445 static enum prop_handled
4446 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4448 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4449 struct text_pos *position;
4450 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4451 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4452 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4454 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4456 object = it->string;
4457 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4458 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4460 else
4462 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4463 position = &it->current.pos;
4464 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4467 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4468 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4469 it->space_width = Qnil;
4470 it->font_height = Qnil;
4471 it->voffset = 0;
4473 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4474 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4475 `display' property etc. */
4476 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4477 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4479 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4480 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4481 if (NILP (propval))
4482 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4483 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4484 if it was a text property. */
4486 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4487 object = it->w->buffer;
4489 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4490 position, bufpos,
4491 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4493 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4496 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4497 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4498 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4499 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4500 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4501 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4503 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4504 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4505 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4507 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4508 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4509 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4510 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4511 spec. */
4512 static int
4513 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4514 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4515 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4517 int replacing_p = 0;
4518 int rv;
4520 if (CONSP (spec)
4521 /* Simple specifications. */
4522 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4523 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4524 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4525 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4526 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4527 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4528 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4529 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4530 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4531 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4532 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4533 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4535 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4537 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4538 overlay, position, bufpos,
4539 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4541 replacing_p = rv;
4542 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4543 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4544 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4545 break;
4549 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4551 ptrdiff_t i;
4552 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4553 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4554 overlay, position, bufpos,
4555 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4557 replacing_p = rv;
4558 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4559 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4560 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4561 break;
4564 else
4566 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4567 position, bufpos, 0,
4568 frame_window_p)))
4569 replacing_p = rv;
4572 return replacing_p;
4575 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4576 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4578 static struct text_pos
4579 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4581 Lisp_Object end;
4582 struct text_pos end_pos;
4584 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4585 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4586 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4587 if (STRINGP (object))
4588 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4589 else
4590 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4592 return end_pos;
4596 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4597 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4598 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4599 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4600 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4601 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4602 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4603 properties after the first one has been processed.
4605 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4606 or nil if it was a text property.
4608 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4609 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4610 property ends.
4612 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4613 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4614 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4616 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4617 of buffer or string text. */
4619 static int
4620 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4621 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4622 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4623 int frame_window_p)
4625 Lisp_Object form;
4626 Lisp_Object location, value;
4627 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4628 int valid_p;
4630 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4631 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4632 form = Qt;
4633 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4635 spec = XCDR (spec);
4636 if (!CONSP (spec))
4637 return 0;
4638 form = XCAR (spec);
4639 spec = XCDR (spec);
4642 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4644 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4645 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4647 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4648 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4649 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4650 to the current position in the buffer. */
4652 if (NILP (object))
4653 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4654 specbind (Qobject, object);
4655 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4656 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4657 GCPRO1 (form);
4658 form = safe_eval (form);
4659 UNGCPRO;
4660 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4663 if (NILP (form))
4664 return 0;
4666 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4667 if (CONSP (spec)
4668 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4669 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4671 if (it)
4673 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4674 return 0;
4676 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4677 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4679 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4680 int new_height = -1;
4682 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4683 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4684 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4685 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4686 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4688 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4689 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4690 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4691 steps = - steps;
4692 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4694 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4696 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4697 Value is the new height. */
4698 Lisp_Object height;
4699 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4700 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4701 if (NUMBERP (height))
4702 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4704 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4706 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4707 struct face *f;
4709 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4710 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4711 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4712 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4714 else
4716 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4717 current specified height to get the new height. */
4718 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4720 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4721 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4722 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4724 if (NUMBERP (value))
4725 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4728 if (new_height > 0)
4729 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4733 return 0;
4736 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4737 if (CONSP (spec)
4738 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4739 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4741 if (it)
4743 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4744 return 0;
4746 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4747 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4748 it->space_width = value;
4751 return 0;
4754 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4755 if (CONSP (spec)
4756 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4758 Lisp_Object tem;
4760 if (it)
4762 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4763 return 0;
4765 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4767 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4768 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4770 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4771 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4773 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4774 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4775 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4781 return 0;
4784 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4785 if (CONSP (spec)
4786 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4787 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4789 if (it)
4791 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4792 return 0;
4794 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4795 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4796 if (NUMBERP (value))
4798 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4799 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4800 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4802 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4805 return 0;
4808 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4809 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4810 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4811 return 0;
4813 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4814 we have to find the end of the property. */
4815 if (it)
4817 start_pos = *position;
4818 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4820 value = Qnil;
4822 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4823 text properties change there. */
4824 if (it)
4825 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4827 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4828 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4829 if (CONSP (spec)
4830 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4831 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4832 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4834 int fringe_bitmap;
4836 if (it)
4838 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4839 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4840 across the text with this property. */
4842 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4843 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4844 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4845 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4846 if (it->bidi_p)
4848 it->position = *position;
4849 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4850 *position = it->position;
4852 return 1;
4855 else if (!frame_window_p)
4856 return 1;
4858 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4859 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4860 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4861 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4862 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4863 across the text with this property. */
4865 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4867 it->position = *position;
4868 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4869 *position = it->position;
4871 return 1;
4874 if (it)
4876 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4878 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4880 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4881 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4882 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4883 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4884 face_id = face_id2;
4887 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4888 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4889 push_it (it, position);
4891 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4892 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4893 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4894 it->position = start_pos;
4895 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4896 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4897 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4898 it->face_id = face_id;
4899 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4901 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4902 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4903 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4904 *position = start_pos;
4906 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4908 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4909 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4911 else
4913 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4914 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4917 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4918 return 1;
4921 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4922 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4923 prefixes for display specifications. */
4924 location = Qunbound;
4925 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4927 Lisp_Object tem;
4929 value = XCDR (spec);
4930 if (CONSP (value))
4931 value = XCAR (value);
4933 tem = XCAR (spec);
4934 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4935 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4936 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4937 (NILP (tem)
4938 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4939 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4940 location = tem;
4943 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4945 location = Qnil;
4946 value = spec;
4949 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4950 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4951 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4953 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4954 `right-margin' or nil. */
4956 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4957 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4958 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4959 && valid_image_p (value))
4960 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4961 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4963 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4965 int retval = 1;
4967 if (!it)
4969 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4970 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4971 display. */
4972 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4973 retval = 2;
4974 return retval;
4977 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4978 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4979 push_it (it, position);
4980 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4981 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4983 if (NILP (location))
4984 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4985 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4986 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4987 else
4988 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4990 if (STRINGP (value))
4992 it->string = value;
4993 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4994 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4995 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4996 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4997 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4998 it->stop_charpos = 0;
4999 it->prev_stop = 0;
5000 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5001 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
5002 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5003 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5004 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5005 if (BUFFERP (object))
5006 *position = start_pos;
5008 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5009 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
5010 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
5011 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5012 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5013 else
5014 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5016 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
5017 if (it->bidi_p)
5019 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5020 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5021 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
5022 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
5023 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
5024 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5025 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5028 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
5030 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
5031 it->object = value;
5032 *position = it->position = start_pos;
5033 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
5035 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
5036 else
5038 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5039 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5040 it->position = start_pos;
5041 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
5042 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5044 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5045 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5046 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5047 *position = start_pos;
5049 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5051 return retval;
5054 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5055 POSITION to what it was before. */
5056 *position = start_pos;
5057 return 0;
5060 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5061 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5062 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5063 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5066 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5067 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5069 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5070 struct text_pos position;
5072 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5073 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5074 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5078 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5080 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5081 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5082 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5083 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5084 modified in sync. */
5086 static int
5087 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5089 if (EQ (string, prop))
5090 return 1;
5092 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5093 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5095 prop = XCDR (prop);
5096 if (!CONSP (prop))
5097 return 0;
5098 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5099 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5100 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5101 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5102 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5103 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5104 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5105 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5106 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5107 its result is non-nil. */
5108 prop = XCDR (prop);
5111 if (CONSP (prop))
5112 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5113 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5115 prop = XCDR (prop);
5116 if (!CONSP (prop))
5117 return 0;
5119 prop = XCDR (prop);
5120 if (!CONSP (prop))
5121 return 0;
5124 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5128 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5130 static int
5131 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5133 if (CONSP (prop)
5134 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5135 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5137 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5138 while (CONSP (prop))
5140 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5141 return 1;
5142 prop = XCDR (prop);
5145 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5147 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5148 ptrdiff_t i;
5149 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5150 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5151 return 1;
5153 else
5154 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5156 return 0;
5159 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5160 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5161 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5162 less than FROM).
5163 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5164 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5166 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5167 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5169 static ptrdiff_t
5170 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5171 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5173 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5174 int found = 0;
5176 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5178 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5180 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5181 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5183 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5184 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5185 found = 1;
5186 else
5187 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5188 limit);
5191 else /* looking back */
5193 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5194 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5196 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5197 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5198 found = 1;
5199 else
5200 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5201 limit);
5205 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5208 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5209 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5210 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5212 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5213 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5214 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5215 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5217 static ptrdiff_t
5218 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5220 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5221 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5222 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5225 if (!found)
5226 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5227 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5228 return found;
5233 /***********************************************************************
5234 `composition' property
5235 ***********************************************************************/
5237 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5238 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5240 static enum prop_handled
5241 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5243 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5244 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5246 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5248 unsigned char *s;
5250 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5251 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5252 string = it->string;
5253 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5254 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5256 else
5258 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5259 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5260 string = Qnil;
5261 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5264 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5265 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5266 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5267 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5268 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5269 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5271 if (start < pos)
5272 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5273 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5274 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5275 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5276 if (start != pos)
5278 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5279 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5280 else
5281 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5283 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5284 prop, string);
5286 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5288 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5289 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5290 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5294 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5299 /***********************************************************************
5300 Overlay strings
5301 ***********************************************************************/
5303 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5304 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5306 struct overlay_entry
5308 Lisp_Object overlay;
5309 Lisp_Object string;
5310 EMACS_INT priority;
5311 int after_string_p;
5315 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5316 Called from handle_stop. */
5318 static enum prop_handled
5319 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5321 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5322 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5323 else
5324 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5328 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5329 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5330 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5331 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5332 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5333 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5335 static void
5336 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5338 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5339 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5341 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5342 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5343 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5345 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5346 pop_it (it);
5347 eassert (it->sp > 0
5348 || (NILP (it->string)
5349 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5350 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5351 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5352 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5353 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5354 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5355 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5356 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5357 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5358 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5359 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5360 pop_it (it);
5362 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5363 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5364 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5365 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5366 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5368 else
5370 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5371 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5372 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5373 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5374 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5375 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5376 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5378 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5379 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5381 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5382 string. */
5383 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5384 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5385 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5386 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5387 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5388 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5389 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5390 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5391 it->prev_stop = 0;
5392 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5394 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5395 if (it->bidi_p)
5397 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5398 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5399 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5400 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5401 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5402 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5403 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5407 CHECK_IT (it);
5411 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5412 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5413 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5415 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5416 when they come from the same overlay.
5418 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5419 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5421 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5422 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5424 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5427 static int
5428 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5430 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5431 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5432 int result;
5434 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5436 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5437 they come from different overlays. */
5438 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5439 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5440 else
5441 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5443 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5445 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5446 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5447 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5448 else
5449 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5450 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5452 else
5453 result = 0;
5455 return result;
5459 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5460 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5461 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5463 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5464 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5465 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5466 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5467 function.
5469 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5470 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5471 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5472 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5473 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5474 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5475 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5476 in this case.
5478 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5479 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5480 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5481 compare_overlay_entries. */
5483 static void
5484 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5486 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5487 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5488 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5489 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5490 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5491 int invis_p;
5492 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5493 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5495 if (charpos <= 0)
5496 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5498 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5499 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5500 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5501 OVERLAY. */
5502 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5503 do \
5505 Lisp_Object priority; \
5507 if (n == size) \
5509 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5510 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5511 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5512 size *= 2; \
5515 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5516 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5517 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5518 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5519 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5520 ++n; \
5522 while (0)
5524 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5525 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5527 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5528 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5529 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5530 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5532 if (end < charpos)
5533 break;
5535 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5536 position. */
5537 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5538 continue;
5540 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5541 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5542 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5543 continue;
5545 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5546 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5547 end position are indistinguishable. */
5548 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5549 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5551 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5552 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5553 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5554 && SCHARS (str))
5555 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5557 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5558 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5559 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5560 && SCHARS (str))
5561 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5564 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5565 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5567 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5568 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5569 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5570 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5572 if (start > charpos)
5573 break;
5575 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5576 position. */
5577 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5578 continue;
5580 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5581 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5582 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5583 continue;
5585 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5586 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5587 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5588 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5590 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5591 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5592 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5593 && SCHARS (str))
5594 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5596 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5597 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5598 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5599 && SCHARS (str))
5600 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5603 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5605 /* Sort entries. */
5606 if (n > 1)
5607 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5609 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5610 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5611 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5613 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5614 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5615 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5616 i = 0;
5617 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5618 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5620 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5621 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5624 CHECK_IT (it);
5625 SAFE_FREE ();
5629 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5630 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5631 least one overlay string was found. */
5633 static int
5634 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5636 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5637 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5638 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5639 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5640 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5641 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5642 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5643 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5644 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5646 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5647 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5648 from current_buffer. */
5649 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5651 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5652 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5653 strings. */
5654 if (compute_stop_p)
5655 compute_stop_pos (it);
5656 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5658 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5659 strings have been processed. */
5660 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5662 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5663 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5664 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5665 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5666 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5667 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5668 in case of an empty display string is in
5669 next_overlay_string.) */
5670 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5671 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5672 push_it (it, NULL);
5674 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5675 string. */
5676 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5677 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5678 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5679 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5680 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5681 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5682 it->prev_stop = 0;
5683 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5684 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5685 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5686 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5688 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5689 buffer. */
5690 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5691 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5692 else
5693 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5695 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5696 if (it->bidi_p)
5698 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5700 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5701 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5702 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5703 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5704 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5705 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5706 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5708 return 1;
5711 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5712 return 0;
5715 static int
5716 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5718 it->string = Qnil;
5719 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5721 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5723 CHECK_IT (it);
5725 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5726 return STRINGP (it->string);
5731 /***********************************************************************
5732 Saving and restoring state
5733 ***********************************************************************/
5735 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5736 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5737 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5738 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5739 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5741 static void
5742 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5744 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5746 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5747 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5749 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5750 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5751 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5752 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5753 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5754 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5755 p->string = it->string;
5756 p->method = it->method;
5757 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5758 switch (p->method)
5760 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5761 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5762 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5763 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5764 break;
5765 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5766 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5767 break;
5769 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5770 p->current = it->current;
5771 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5772 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5773 p->area = it->area;
5774 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5775 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5776 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5777 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5778 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5779 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5780 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5781 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5782 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5783 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5784 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5785 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5786 ++it->sp;
5788 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5789 if (it->bidi_p)
5790 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5793 static void
5794 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5796 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5797 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5798 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5800 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5802 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5803 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5804 chance to do that. */
5805 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5806 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5807 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5808 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5809 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5810 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5811 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5812 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5813 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5814 back, maybe. */
5815 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5816 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5817 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5818 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5819 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5820 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5821 if (buffer_p)
5822 it->current.pos = it->position;
5823 else
5824 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5827 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5828 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5829 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5830 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5831 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5833 static void
5834 pop_it (struct it *it)
5836 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5837 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5839 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5840 --it->sp;
5841 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5842 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5843 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5844 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5845 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5846 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5847 it->current = p->current;
5848 it->position = p->position;
5849 it->string = p->string;
5850 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5851 if (NILP (it->string))
5852 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5853 it->method = p->method;
5854 switch (it->method)
5856 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5857 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5858 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5859 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5860 break;
5861 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5862 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5863 break;
5864 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5865 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5866 break;
5867 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5868 it->object = it->string;
5869 break;
5870 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5871 if (it->s)
5872 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5873 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5874 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5875 else
5877 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5878 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5881 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5882 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5883 it->area = p->area;
5884 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5885 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5886 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5887 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5888 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5889 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5890 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5891 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5892 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5893 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5894 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5895 if (it->bidi_p)
5897 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5898 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5899 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5900 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5901 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5902 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5903 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5904 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5905 if (from_display_prop
5906 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5907 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5909 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5910 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5911 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5912 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5913 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5914 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5915 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5921 /***********************************************************************
5922 Moving over lines
5923 ***********************************************************************/
5925 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5927 static void
5928 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5930 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5931 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5935 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5937 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5938 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5939 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5940 of *SKIPPED_P.
5942 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5943 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5945 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5946 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5947 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5949 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5950 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5951 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5952 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5953 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5954 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5956 static int
5957 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5958 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5960 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
5961 int newline_found_p, n;
5962 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5964 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5965 skipping over invisible text below. */
5966 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5967 && it->c == '\n'
5968 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5970 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5971 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5973 it->c = 0;
5974 return 1;
5977 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5978 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5979 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5980 calls this function. */
5981 old_selective = it->selective;
5982 it->selective = 0;
5984 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5985 from buffer text. */
5986 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5987 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5988 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5990 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5991 return 0;
5992 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5993 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5994 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5995 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5998 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
5999 short-cut. */
6000 if (!newline_found_p)
6002 ptrdiff_t start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6003 ptrdiff_t limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
6004 Lisp_Object pos;
6006 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
6008 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
6009 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
6010 buffer text. */
6011 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
6012 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
6013 Qdisplay, Qnil,
6014 make_number (limit)),
6015 NILP (pos))
6016 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
6018 if (!it->bidi_p)
6020 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6021 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
6023 else
6025 struct bidi_it bprev;
6027 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
6028 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
6029 none up to `limit'. */
6030 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
6032 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
6033 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
6035 do {
6036 bprev = it->bidi_it;
6037 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
6038 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6039 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6040 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6041 if (bidi_it_prev)
6042 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6044 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
6046 else
6048 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6049 && !newline_found_p)
6051 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6052 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6053 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6054 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6059 it->selective = old_selective;
6060 return newline_found_p;
6064 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6065 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6066 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6067 IT->hpos. */
6069 static void
6070 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6072 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6074 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6076 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6077 break;
6079 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6080 invisible. */
6081 if (it->selective > 0
6082 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6083 it->selective))
6084 continue;
6086 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6088 Lisp_Object prop;
6089 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6090 Qinvisible, it->window);
6091 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6092 continue;
6095 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6096 break;
6099 struct it it2;
6100 void *it2data = NULL;
6101 ptrdiff_t pos;
6102 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6103 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6105 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6107 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6108 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6109 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6110 goto replaced;
6112 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6113 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6114 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6115 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6116 it2.sp = 0;
6117 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6118 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6119 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6120 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6121 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6122 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6123 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6124 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6125 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6127 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6128 goto replaced;
6131 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6132 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6133 break;
6135 replaced:
6136 if (beg < BEGV)
6137 beg = BEGV;
6138 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6139 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6143 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6145 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6146 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6147 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6148 CHECK_IT (it);
6152 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6153 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6154 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6155 face information etc. */
6157 void
6158 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6160 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6161 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6162 CHECK_IT (it);
6166 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6167 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6168 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6169 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6170 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6171 is invisible because of text properties. */
6173 static void
6174 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6176 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6177 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6179 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6181 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6182 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6183 if (it->selective > 0)
6184 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6185 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6186 it->selective))
6188 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6189 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6190 newline_found_p =
6191 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6194 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6195 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6197 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6199 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6201 if (!it->bidi_p)
6203 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6204 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6206 else
6208 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6209 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6210 position with that. */
6211 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6212 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6213 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6217 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6219 if (!it->bidi_p)
6221 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6222 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6224 else
6226 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6227 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6228 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6229 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6230 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6232 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6235 else if (skipped_p)
6236 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6238 CHECK_IT (it);
6243 /***********************************************************************
6244 Changing an iterator's position
6245 ***********************************************************************/
6247 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6248 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6249 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6250 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6252 static void
6253 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6255 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6257 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6259 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6260 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6261 if (force_p
6262 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6263 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6265 if (it->bidi_p)
6267 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6268 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6269 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6270 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6271 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6272 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6273 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6274 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6275 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6276 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6277 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6278 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6279 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6280 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6281 handle_stop (it);
6283 else
6285 handle_stop (it);
6286 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6291 CHECK_IT (it);
6295 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6296 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6298 static void
6299 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6301 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6302 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6304 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6305 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6307 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6308 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6309 it->dpvec = NULL;
6310 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6311 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6312 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6313 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6314 it->string = Qnil;
6315 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6316 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6317 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6318 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6319 it->sp = 0;
6320 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6321 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6323 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6324 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6325 if (it->bidi_p)
6327 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6328 &it->bidi_it);
6329 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6330 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6331 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6332 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6333 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6334 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6337 if (set_stop_p)
6339 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6340 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6342 /* This make the information stored in it->cmp_it invalidate. */
6343 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6347 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6348 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6349 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6351 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6352 characters from the string.
6354 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6355 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6356 field width.
6358 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6359 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6360 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6362 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6363 calling this function. */
6365 static void
6366 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6367 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6368 int multibyte)
6370 /* No region in strings. */
6371 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6373 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6374 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6376 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6377 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6378 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6379 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6380 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6382 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6383 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6384 if (multibyte >= 0)
6385 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6387 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6388 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6389 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6390 not yet available. */
6391 it->bidi_p =
6392 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6393 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6395 if (s == NULL)
6397 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6398 it->string = string;
6399 it->s = NULL;
6400 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6401 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6402 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6404 if (it->bidi_p)
6406 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6407 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6408 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6409 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6410 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6411 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6412 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6413 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6416 else
6418 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6419 it->string = Qnil;
6421 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6422 for displaying C strings. */
6423 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6424 if (it->multibyte_p)
6426 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6427 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6429 else
6431 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6432 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6435 if (it->bidi_p)
6437 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6438 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6439 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6440 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6441 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6442 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6443 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6444 &it->bidi_it);
6446 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6449 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6450 from the string. */
6451 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6453 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6454 if (it->bidi_p)
6455 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6458 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6459 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6460 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6461 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6462 if (field_width < 0)
6463 field_width = INFINITY;
6464 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6465 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6466 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6467 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6468 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6470 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6471 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6472 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6474 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6475 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6476 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6477 if (it->bidi_p)
6479 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6480 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6481 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6483 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6485 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6486 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6487 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6488 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6489 it->string);
6491 CHECK_IT (it);
6496 /***********************************************************************
6497 Iteration
6498 ***********************************************************************/
6500 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6502 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6504 next_element_from_buffer,
6505 next_element_from_display_vector,
6506 next_element_from_string,
6507 next_element_from_c_string,
6508 next_element_from_image,
6509 next_element_from_stretch
6512 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6515 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6516 (possibly with the following characters). */
6518 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6519 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6520 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6521 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6522 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6523 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6524 (IT)->string)))
6527 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6528 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6529 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6530 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6531 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6532 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6534 Lisp_Object
6535 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6537 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6539 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6540 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6542 if (c >= 0)
6544 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6545 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6546 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6547 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6548 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6550 else
6551 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6554 retry:
6555 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6557 if (c >= 0)
6558 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6559 return Qnil;
6560 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6561 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6563 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6565 if (c >= 0)
6566 return glyphless_method;
6567 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6568 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6570 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6571 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6572 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6573 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6574 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6575 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6576 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6577 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6578 else
6580 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6581 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6582 goto retry;
6584 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6585 return glyphless_method;
6588 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6589 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6590 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6592 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6593 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6594 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6596 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6597 int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6598 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6600 static int
6601 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6603 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6604 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6605 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6606 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6607 int success_p;
6609 get_next:
6610 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6612 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6614 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6615 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6616 is R..." */
6617 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6618 tables? */
6619 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6620 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6621 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6622 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6623 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6624 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6625 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6626 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6627 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6628 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6629 it? */
6630 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6632 Lisp_Object dv;
6633 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6634 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6635 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6636 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6638 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6640 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6641 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6643 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6644 if (c < 0)
6645 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6647 else
6648 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6651 if (it->dp
6652 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6653 VECTORP (dv)))
6655 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6657 /* Return the first character from the display table
6658 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6659 current character. */
6660 if (v->header.size)
6662 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6663 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6664 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6665 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6666 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6667 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6668 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6669 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6671 else
6673 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6675 goto get_next;
6678 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6680 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6681 goto done;
6682 /* Don't display this character. */
6683 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6684 goto get_next;
6687 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6688 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6689 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6691 if (c == 0xA0)
6692 nonascii_space_p = 1;
6693 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6694 nonascii_hyphen_p = 1;
6697 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6698 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6699 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6700 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6701 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6703 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6704 translated too.
6706 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6707 translated to octal form. */
6708 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6709 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6710 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6711 || (c != '\t'
6712 && it->glyph_row
6713 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6714 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6715 : (nonascii_space_p
6716 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6717 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6718 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6720 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6721 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6722 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6723 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6724 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6725 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6726 Lisp_Object gc;
6727 int ctl_len;
6728 int face_id;
6729 int lface_id = 0;
6730 int escape_glyph;
6732 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6734 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6736 int g;
6738 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6739 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6740 if (it->dp
6741 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6743 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6744 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6746 if (lface_id)
6748 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6750 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6751 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6753 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6755 else
6757 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6758 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6759 it->face_id);
6760 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6761 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6762 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6765 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6766 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6767 ctl_len = 2;
6768 goto display_control;
6771 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6772 highlighting. */
6774 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6776 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6777 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6778 it->face_id);
6779 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6780 ctl_len = 1;
6781 goto display_control;
6784 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6786 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6787 escape_glyph = '\\';
6789 if (it->dp
6790 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6792 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6793 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6795 if (lface_id)
6797 /* The display table specified a face.
6798 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6799 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6800 it->face_id);
6802 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6803 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6805 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6807 else
6809 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6810 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6811 it->face_id);
6812 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6813 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6814 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6817 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6819 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6821 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6822 ctl_len = 1;
6823 goto display_control;
6826 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6828 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6830 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6831 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6832 ctl_len = 2;
6833 goto display_control;
6837 char str[10];
6838 int len, i;
6840 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6841 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6842 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6843 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6845 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6846 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6847 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6848 ctl_len = len + 1;
6851 display_control:
6852 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6853 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6854 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6855 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6856 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6857 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6858 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6859 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6860 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6861 goto get_next;
6863 it->char_to_display = c;
6865 else if (success_p)
6867 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6871 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6872 character in unibyte text. */
6873 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6874 && it->multibyte_p
6875 && success_p
6876 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6878 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6880 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6882 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6883 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6885 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6887 else
6889 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6890 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6891 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6892 int c;
6894 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6895 c = it->char_to_display;
6896 else
6898 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6899 int i;
6901 c = ' ';
6902 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6903 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6904 padding space on the left or right. */
6905 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6906 break;
6908 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6912 done:
6913 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6914 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6915 if (it->face_box_p
6916 && it->s == NULL)
6918 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6920 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6921 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6923 if (face)
6925 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6927 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6928 display string, check faces in that string. */
6929 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6930 it->end_of_box_run_p
6931 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6932 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6934 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6935 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6936 the next buffer location. */
6937 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6938 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6939 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6941 ptrdiff_t ignore;
6942 int next_face_id;
6943 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6944 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6946 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6947 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6948 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6949 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6950 -1);
6951 it->end_of_box_run_p
6952 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6953 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6957 else
6959 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6960 it->end_of_box_run_p
6961 = (face_id != it->face_id
6962 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6965 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
6966 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
6967 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
6968 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
6969 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
6970 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
6972 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6973 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
6976 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6977 return success_p;
6981 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6983 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6984 skip to the next visible line start.
6986 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6987 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6988 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6989 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6990 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6991 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6992 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6993 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6994 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6996 void
6997 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
6999 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
7000 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
7001 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
7002 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
7004 switch (it->method)
7006 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
7007 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
7008 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
7009 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
7010 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
7011 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
7012 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7014 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
7015 int i;
7017 if (! it->bidi_p)
7019 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7020 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7021 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7023 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7025 else
7027 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7028 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7029 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7030 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
7033 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7035 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
7036 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
7037 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
7038 character visually after the current composition. */
7039 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7040 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7041 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7042 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7044 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7046 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7047 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7049 else
7051 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7052 Find the next stop position. */
7053 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7054 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7055 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7056 where to stop. */
7057 stop = -1;
7058 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7059 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7062 else
7064 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7065 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7066 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7067 character visually after the current composition. */
7068 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7069 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7070 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7071 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7072 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7074 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7075 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7077 else
7079 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7080 Find the next stop position. */
7081 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7082 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7083 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7084 where to stop. */
7085 stop = -1;
7086 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7087 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7091 else
7093 eassert (it->len != 0);
7095 if (!it->bidi_p)
7097 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7098 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7100 else
7102 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7103 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7104 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7105 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7106 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7107 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7108 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7109 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7110 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7112 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7113 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7114 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7115 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7116 stop = -1;
7117 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7118 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7121 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7123 break;
7125 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7126 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7127 if (!it->bidi_p
7128 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7129 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7130 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7131 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7132 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7134 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7135 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7137 else
7139 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7140 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7141 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7143 break;
7145 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7146 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7147 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7148 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7149 strings. */
7150 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7152 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7153 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7154 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7156 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7158 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7160 if (it->s)
7161 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7162 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7163 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7164 else
7166 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7167 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7170 it->dpvec = NULL;
7171 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7173 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7174 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7175 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7176 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7178 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7179 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7180 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
7181 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7182 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7185 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
7186 if (recheck_faces)
7187 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7189 break;
7191 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7192 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7193 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7194 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7195 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7196 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7197 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7198 stack. */
7199 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7201 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7202 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7203 where the string ends. */
7204 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7205 goto consider_string_end;
7207 else
7209 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7210 against it->end_charpos . */
7211 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7212 goto consider_string_end;
7214 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7216 int i;
7218 if (! it->bidi_p)
7220 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7221 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7222 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7223 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7224 else
7226 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7227 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7228 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7229 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7230 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7233 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7235 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7236 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7237 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7238 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7240 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7241 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7242 else
7244 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7245 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7246 stop = -1;
7247 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7248 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7249 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7250 it->string);
7253 else
7255 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7256 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7257 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7258 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7259 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7260 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7261 else
7263 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7264 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7265 stop = -1;
7266 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7267 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7268 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7269 it->string);
7273 else
7275 if (!it->bidi_p
7276 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7277 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7278 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7279 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7280 characters. */
7281 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7283 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7284 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7286 else
7288 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7290 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7291 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7292 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7293 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7295 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7297 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7298 stop = -1;
7299 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7300 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7301 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7302 it->string);
7307 consider_string_end:
7309 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7311 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7312 next, if there is one. */
7313 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7315 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7316 next_overlay_string (it);
7317 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7318 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7321 else
7323 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7324 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7325 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7326 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7327 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7328 && it->sp > 0)
7330 pop_it (it);
7331 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7332 goto consider_string_end;
7335 break;
7337 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7338 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7339 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7340 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7341 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7342 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7343 pop_it (it);
7344 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7345 goto consider_string_end;
7346 break;
7348 default:
7349 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7350 emacs_abort ();
7353 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7354 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7355 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7358 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7359 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7360 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7361 or `\003'.
7363 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7364 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7365 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7367 static int
7368 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7370 Lisp_Object gc;
7372 /* Precondition. */
7373 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7375 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7377 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7378 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7379 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7381 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7383 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7384 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7386 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7387 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7388 zero means no face is specified. */
7389 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7390 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7391 else
7393 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7394 if (lface_id > 0)
7395 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7396 it->saved_face_id);
7399 else
7400 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7401 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7403 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7404 still the values of the character that had this display table
7405 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7406 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7407 return 1;
7410 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7411 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7412 static void
7413 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7415 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7416 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7417 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7419 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7421 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7422 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7424 else
7426 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7427 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7430 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7432 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7433 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7434 call it. */
7435 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7437 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7438 || (!string_p
7439 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7440 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7442 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7443 the next element right away. */
7444 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7445 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7447 else
7449 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7451 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7452 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7453 next element. */
7454 if (string_p)
7455 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7456 else
7458 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7459 -1);
7460 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7462 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7465 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7466 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7467 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7469 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7470 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7473 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7474 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7476 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7477 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7479 else
7481 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7482 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7485 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7487 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7489 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7491 eassert (!it->s);
7492 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7493 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7494 stop = it->end_charpos;
7495 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7496 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7498 else
7500 stop = it->end_charpos;
7501 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7502 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7504 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7505 stop = -1;
7506 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7507 it->string);
7511 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7512 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7513 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7514 overlay string. */
7516 static int
7517 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7519 struct text_pos position;
7521 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7522 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7523 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7524 position = it->current.string_pos;
7526 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7527 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7528 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7529 direction is not known. */
7530 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7532 get_visually_first_element (it);
7533 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7536 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7537 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7539 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7541 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7542 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7543 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7545 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7546 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7547 with several other stop positions in between that we
7548 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7549 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7550 that precedes our current position. */
7551 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7552 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7554 else
7556 if (it->bidi_p)
7558 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7559 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7560 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7561 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7562 note of the last stop position seen at this
7563 level. */
7564 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7565 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7567 handle_stop (it);
7569 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7570 recurse here. */
7571 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7574 else if (it->bidi_p
7575 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7576 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7577 to handle that stop_pos. */
7578 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7579 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7580 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7581 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7582 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7583 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7585 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7586 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7587 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7588 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7589 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7590 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7591 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7592 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7593 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7597 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7599 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7600 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7601 do. */
7602 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7604 it->what = IT_EOB;
7605 return 0;
7607 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7608 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7609 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7610 ? -1
7611 : SCHARS (it->string))
7612 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7614 return 1;
7616 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7618 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7619 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7620 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7622 else
7624 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7625 it->len = 1;
7628 else
7630 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7631 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7632 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7633 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7634 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7636 it->what = IT_EOB;
7637 return 0;
7639 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7641 /* Pad with spaces. */
7642 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7643 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7645 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7646 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7647 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7648 ? -1
7649 : it->string_nchars)
7650 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7652 return 1;
7654 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7656 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7657 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7658 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7660 else
7662 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7663 it->len = 1;
7667 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7668 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7669 it->object = it->string;
7670 it->position = position;
7671 return 1;
7675 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7676 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7677 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7678 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7679 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7680 reached, including padding spaces. */
7682 static int
7683 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7685 int success_p = 1;
7687 eassert (it->s);
7688 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7689 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7690 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7691 it->object = Qnil;
7693 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7694 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7695 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7696 not known. */
7697 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7698 get_visually_first_element (it);
7700 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7701 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7702 initialized. */
7703 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7705 /* End of the game. */
7706 it->what = IT_EOB;
7707 success_p = 0;
7709 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7711 /* Pad with spaces. */
7712 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7713 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7715 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7716 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7717 else
7718 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7720 return success_p;
7724 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7725 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7726 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7727 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7729 static int
7730 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7732 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7733 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7734 else
7736 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7737 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7738 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7739 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7740 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7741 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7742 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7743 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7744 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7747 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7751 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7752 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7753 is always 1. */
7756 static int
7757 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7759 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7760 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7761 return 1;
7765 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7766 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7767 always 1. */
7769 static int
7770 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7772 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7773 return 1;
7776 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7777 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7778 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7779 reordering bidirectional text. */
7781 static void
7782 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7784 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7785 struct text_pos pos;
7786 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7787 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7788 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7789 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7790 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7791 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7793 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7794 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7795 it->bidi_p = 0;
7798 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7799 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7800 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7801 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7802 compute_stop_pos (it);
7803 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7804 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7805 emacs_abort ();
7807 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7809 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7810 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7811 else
7812 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7813 it->bidi_p = 1;
7814 it->current = save_current;
7815 it->position = save_position;
7816 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7817 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7820 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7821 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7822 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7823 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7824 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7825 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7826 position. */
7828 static void
7829 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7831 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7832 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7833 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7834 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7835 struct text_pos pos1;
7836 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7838 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7839 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7840 it->bidi_p = 0;
7843 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7844 if (bufp)
7846 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7847 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7849 else
7850 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7851 compute_stop_pos (it);
7852 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7853 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7854 emacs_abort ();
7855 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7857 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7859 it->bidi_p = 1;
7860 it->current = save_current;
7861 it->position = save_position;
7862 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7863 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7864 handle_stop (it);
7865 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7868 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7869 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7870 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7871 end. */
7873 static int
7874 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7876 int success_p = 1;
7878 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7879 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7880 eassert (!it->bidi_p
7881 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7882 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7884 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7885 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7886 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7887 a different paragraph. */
7888 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7890 get_visually_first_element (it);
7891 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7894 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7896 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7898 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7900 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7901 haven't been returned yet. */
7902 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7903 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7904 else
7906 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7907 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7910 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7911 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7912 else
7914 it->what = IT_EOB;
7915 it->position = it->current.pos;
7916 success_p = 0;
7919 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7920 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7921 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7923 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7924 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7925 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7926 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7927 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7928 current position. */
7929 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7930 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7932 else
7934 if (it->bidi_p)
7936 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7937 for when we will move back across it. */
7938 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7939 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7940 note of the last stop position seen at this
7941 level. */
7942 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7943 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7945 handle_stop (it);
7946 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7949 else if (it->bidi_p
7950 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7951 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7952 handle that stop_pos. */
7953 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7954 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7955 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7956 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7957 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7958 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7960 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7961 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7963 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7964 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7965 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7966 vertical-motion. */
7967 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7968 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7969 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7971 else
7972 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7973 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7975 else
7977 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7978 character from current_buffer. */
7979 unsigned char *p;
7980 ptrdiff_t stop;
7982 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7983 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7984 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7985 && it->glyph_row
7986 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7987 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7989 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7990 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7991 stop)
7992 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7994 return 1;
7997 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7998 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7999 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
8000 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
8001 else
8002 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
8004 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
8005 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
8006 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8007 it->position = it->current.pos;
8009 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
8010 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
8011 if (it->selective)
8013 if (it->c == '\n')
8015 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
8016 than that number of columns. */
8017 if (it->selective > 0
8018 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
8019 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
8020 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
8021 it->selective))
8023 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8024 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8027 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
8029 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
8030 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
8031 ellipsis displayed for it. */
8032 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
8033 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
8038 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
8039 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
8040 return success_p;
8044 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8046 static void
8047 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8049 Lisp_Object args[3];
8051 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8052 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8053 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8055 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8056 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8057 args[1] = it->window;
8058 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8059 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8061 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8062 them again, even if they get an error. */
8063 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8064 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8066 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8067 handle_face_prop (it);
8071 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8072 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8073 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8074 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8076 static int
8077 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8079 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8080 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8081 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8083 if (it->c < 0)
8085 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8086 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8087 return 0;
8089 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8090 it->object = it->string;
8091 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8092 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8094 else
8096 if (it->c < 0)
8098 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8099 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8100 if (it->bidi_p)
8102 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8103 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8104 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8105 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8106 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8107 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8109 return 0;
8111 it->position = it->current.pos;
8112 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8113 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8114 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8116 return 1;
8121 /***********************************************************************
8122 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8123 ***********************************************************************/
8125 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8126 position after some move_it_ call. */
8128 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8129 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8130 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8131 : 1)
8134 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8135 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8137 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8138 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8139 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8140 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8142 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8143 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8144 scroll amount.
8146 The return value has several possible values that
8147 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8149 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8150 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8152 MOVE_X_REACHED
8153 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8155 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8156 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8157 be continued.
8159 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8160 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8161 truncated.
8163 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8164 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8165 display is on. */
8167 static enum move_it_result
8168 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8169 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8170 enum move_operation_enum op)
8172 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8173 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8174 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8175 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8176 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8177 int may_wrap = 0;
8178 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8179 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8180 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8182 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8183 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8184 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8186 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8187 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8188 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8189 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8190 pixel positions. */
8191 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8192 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8193 atx_it.sp = -1;
8195 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8196 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8197 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8198 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8199 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8200 if (it->bidi_p)
8202 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8203 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8204 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8205 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8208 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8209 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8210 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8211 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8212 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8213 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8214 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8215 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8216 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8217 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8218 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8219 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8220 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8221 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8222 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8224 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8225 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8226 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8227 handle_line_prefix (it);
8229 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8230 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8232 while (1)
8234 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8236 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8237 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8238 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8239 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8241 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8242 display string or stretch glyph). */
8243 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8244 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8245 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8246 && (((!it->bidi_p
8247 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8248 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8249 display in strictly increasing order of their
8250 buffer positions. */
8251 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8252 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8253 || (it->bidi_p
8254 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8255 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8256 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8257 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8258 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8259 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8260 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8261 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8262 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8264 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8266 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8267 break;
8269 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8270 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8271 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8272 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8273 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8276 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8277 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8278 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8279 explicitly below. */
8280 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8282 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8283 break;
8286 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8288 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8290 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8291 break;
8294 else
8296 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8298 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8299 may_wrap = 1;
8300 else if (may_wrap)
8302 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8303 whitespace characters. If the position is
8304 already found, we are done. */
8305 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8307 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8308 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8309 goto done;
8311 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8313 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8314 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8315 goto done;
8317 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8318 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8319 may_wrap = 0;
8324 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8325 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8326 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8327 descent = it->max_descent;
8329 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8330 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8331 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8332 line. */
8333 x = it->current_x;
8335 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8337 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8339 prev_method = it->method;
8340 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8341 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8342 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8343 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8344 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8345 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8346 if (it->bidi_p
8347 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8348 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8349 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8350 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8351 continue;
8354 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8355 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8356 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8357 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8358 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8359 composite character.)
8361 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8362 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8363 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8364 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8365 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8366 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8367 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8368 next line.
8370 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8371 the same width. */
8372 if (it->nglyphs)
8374 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8375 glyphs have the same width. */
8376 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8377 int new_x;
8378 int x_before_this_char = x;
8379 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8381 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8383 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8385 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8386 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8388 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8390 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8391 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8392 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8394 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8395 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8398 else
8400 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8402 it->current_x = x;
8403 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8404 break;
8406 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8408 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8409 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8414 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8415 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8416 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8417 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8418 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8419 system frame. */
8420 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8421 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8422 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8423 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8424 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8426 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8427 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8428 it->hpos == 0
8429 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8430 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8432 ++it->hpos;
8433 it->current_x = new_x;
8435 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8436 in this row. */
8437 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8439 /* If this is the destination position,
8440 return a position *before* it in this row,
8441 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8442 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8444 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8445 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8447 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8448 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8449 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8450 break;
8452 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8453 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8455 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8456 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8457 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8461 prev_method = it->method;
8462 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8463 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8464 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8465 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8466 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8467 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8468 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8469 "overflow" into the fringe if
8470 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8471 On text terminals, and on graphical
8472 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8473 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8474 display line.*/
8475 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8476 || ((it->bidi_p
8477 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8478 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8479 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8480 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8482 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8484 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8485 break;
8487 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8489 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8490 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8491 else
8492 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8493 break;
8495 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8497 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8498 break;
8503 else
8504 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8506 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8508 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8509 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8510 atx_it.sp = -1;
8513 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8514 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8515 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8516 break;
8519 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8521 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8522 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8523 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8525 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8526 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8530 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8532 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8533 would be displayed. */
8534 ++it->hpos;
8538 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8539 break;
8541 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8543 buffer_pos_reached:
8544 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8545 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8546 break;
8548 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8550 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8551 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8552 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8553 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8554 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8555 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8556 break;
8559 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8560 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8562 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8563 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8564 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8565 did. */
8566 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8568 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8570 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8572 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8573 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8575 else
8576 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8578 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8579 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8580 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8581 else
8582 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8584 else
8585 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8586 break;
8589 prev_method = it->method;
8590 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8591 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8592 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8593 to the next. */
8594 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8595 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8596 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8597 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8598 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8599 if (it->bidi_p
8600 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8601 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8602 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8603 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8605 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8606 past the right edge of the window now. */
8607 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8608 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8610 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8611 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8612 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8613 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8614 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8616 int at_eob_p = 0;
8618 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8619 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8620 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8621 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8622 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8623 unidirectional display did. */
8624 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8625 && !saw_smaller_pos
8626 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8628 if (it->bidi_p
8629 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8630 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8631 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8632 break;
8634 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8636 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8637 break;
8640 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8641 && !saw_smaller_pos
8642 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8644 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8645 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8646 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8647 break;
8649 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8650 break;
8652 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8655 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8657 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8658 restore the saved iterator. */
8659 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8660 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8661 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8662 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8664 done:
8666 if (atpos_data)
8667 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8668 if (atx_data)
8669 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8670 if (wrap_data)
8671 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8672 if (ppos_data)
8673 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8675 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8676 function. */
8677 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8678 return result;
8681 /* For external use. */
8682 void
8683 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8684 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8685 enum move_operation_enum op)
8687 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8688 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8690 struct it save_it;
8691 void *save_data = NULL;
8692 int skip;
8694 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8695 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8696 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8697 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8698 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8699 space before the wrap point. */
8700 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8702 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8703 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8704 move_it_in_display_line_to
8705 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8707 else
8708 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8710 else
8711 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8715 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8716 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8718 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8719 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8720 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8722 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8723 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8724 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8726 void
8727 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8729 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8730 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8731 void *backup_data = NULL;
8733 for (;;)
8735 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8737 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8738 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8739 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8741 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8743 reached = 1;
8744 break;
8746 else
8747 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8749 else
8751 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8752 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8753 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8755 reached = 2;
8756 break;
8759 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8761 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8763 reached = 3;
8764 break;
8766 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8768 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8769 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8770 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8771 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8773 reached = 4;
8774 break;
8779 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8781 struct it it_backup;
8783 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8784 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8786 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8787 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8788 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8789 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8790 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8791 TO_X.
8793 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8794 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8795 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8796 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8797 to happen. */
8798 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8799 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8800 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8802 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8803 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8804 reached = 5;
8805 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8807 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8808 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8809 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8810 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8811 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8812 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8813 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8815 reached = 6;
8816 break;
8818 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8819 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8820 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8821 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8822 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8823 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8824 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8826 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8827 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8829 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8830 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8831 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8832 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8833 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8834 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8835 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8836 height. */
8837 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8838 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8840 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8841 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8842 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8843 reached = 6;
8845 else
8847 skip = skip2;
8848 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8849 reached = 7;
8852 else
8854 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8855 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8856 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8858 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8859 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8861 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8862 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8863 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8864 space before the wrap point. */
8865 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8866 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8868 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8869 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8870 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8871 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8873 reached = 6;
8877 if (reached)
8878 break;
8880 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8881 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8882 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8883 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8884 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8885 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8886 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8887 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8888 chance below. */
8889 && !(it->bidi_p
8890 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8891 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8892 else
8893 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8895 switch (skip)
8897 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8898 reached = 8;
8899 goto out;
8901 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8902 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8903 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8904 break;
8906 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8907 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8908 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8909 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8910 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8912 reached = 9;
8913 goto out;
8915 break;
8917 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8918 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8919 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8920 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8921 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8922 if (it->c == '\t')
8924 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8925 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8926 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8927 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8928 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8929 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8930 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8932 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8933 - it->last_visible_x;
8934 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8937 else
8938 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8939 break;
8941 default:
8942 emacs_abort ();
8945 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8946 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8947 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8948 line_start_x = 0;
8949 it->hpos = 0;
8950 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8951 ++it->vpos;
8952 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8953 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8954 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8957 out:
8959 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8960 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8961 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8962 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8963 that brings us offscreen). */
8964 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8965 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8966 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8967 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8968 && it->nglyphs > 1
8969 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8970 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8971 && it->c != '\n'
8972 && it->c != '\t'
8973 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8975 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8976 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8977 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8978 ++it->vpos;
8979 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8980 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8983 if (backup_data)
8984 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8986 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8990 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8992 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8993 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8994 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8995 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8996 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8998 void
8999 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
9001 int nlines, h;
9002 struct it it2, it3;
9003 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
9004 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
9006 move_further_back:
9007 eassert (dy >= 0);
9009 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9011 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
9012 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
9014 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
9015 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9016 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9018 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
9019 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
9020 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
9021 use reseat_1 here. */
9022 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9024 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
9025 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
9026 reordering is in effect. */
9027 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
9029 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
9030 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
9031 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
9032 y-distance. */
9033 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9034 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
9037 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
9038 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9040 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9041 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9042 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9043 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9044 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9045 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9046 START_POS and will not move. */
9047 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9048 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9049 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9050 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9051 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9053 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9054 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9055 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9056 and the starting position. */
9057 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9058 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9059 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9061 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9062 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9063 it->vpos -= nlines;
9064 it->current_y -= h;
9066 if (dy == 0)
9068 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9069 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9070 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9071 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9072 if (nlines > 0)
9073 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9074 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9075 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9076 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9077 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9078 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9079 line. */
9080 if (it->bidi_p
9081 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9082 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9083 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9084 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9086 ptrdiff_t nl_pos =
9087 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
9089 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9091 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9093 else
9095 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9096 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9097 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9098 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9099 int y1;
9100 int line_height;
9102 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9103 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9104 line_height = y1 - y0;
9105 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9106 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9107 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9108 if (target_y < it->current_y
9109 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9110 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9111 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9112 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9113 && (it->current_y - target_y
9114 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9115 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9117 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9118 target_y - it->current_y));
9119 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9120 goto move_further_back;
9122 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9123 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9125 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9127 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9128 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9129 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9130 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9131 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9133 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9134 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9135 else
9139 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9141 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9148 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9149 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9150 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9152 void
9153 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9155 if (dy <= 0)
9156 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9157 else
9159 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9160 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9161 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9162 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9164 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9165 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9166 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9167 && ZV > BEGV
9168 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9169 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9174 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9176 void
9177 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9179 enum move_it_result rc;
9181 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9182 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9183 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9187 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9188 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9189 screen line.
9191 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9192 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9193 truncate-lines nil. */
9195 void
9196 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9199 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9200 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9201 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9202 /* struct position pos;
9203 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9205 struct text_pos textpos;
9207 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9208 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9209 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9210 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9211 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9213 else */
9215 if (dvpos == 0)
9217 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9218 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9219 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
9220 last_height = 0;
9222 else if (dvpos > 0)
9224 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9225 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9227 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9228 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9229 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9230 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9231 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9232 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9233 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9234 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9235 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9236 correctly. */
9237 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9238 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9241 else
9243 struct it it2;
9244 void *it2data = NULL;
9245 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9247 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9248 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9249 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9250 dvpos += it->vpos;
9251 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9252 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9254 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
9255 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9256 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
9257 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9258 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9260 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9261 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9263 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9264 dvpos += it->vpos;
9265 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9266 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9267 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9268 break;
9269 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9270 move further back. */
9271 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9272 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9273 dvpos--;
9276 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9278 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9279 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9280 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9281 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9282 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9283 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9284 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9285 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9287 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9288 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9290 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9292 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9293 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9294 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9295 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9296 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9297 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9298 else
9299 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9301 else
9302 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9306 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9309 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9311 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9312 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9313 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9317 /***********************************************************************
9318 Messages
9319 ***********************************************************************/
9322 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9323 to *Messages*. */
9325 void
9326 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9328 Lisp_Object args[3];
9329 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9330 char *buffer;
9331 ptrdiff_t len;
9332 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9333 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9335 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9336 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9338 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9339 args[1] = arg1;
9340 args[2] = arg2;
9341 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9343 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9344 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9345 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9347 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9348 SAFE_FREE ();
9350 UNGCPRO;
9354 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9356 void
9357 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9359 if (message_log_need_newline)
9360 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9364 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9365 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9366 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9367 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9368 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9370 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9371 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9373 void
9374 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9376 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9378 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9379 return;
9381 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9383 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9384 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9385 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9386 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9387 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9388 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9389 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9391 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9392 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9393 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9394 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9396 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9397 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9398 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9399 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9400 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9401 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9402 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9404 if (PT == Z)
9405 point_at_end = 1;
9406 if (ZV == Z)
9407 zv_at_end = 1;
9409 BEGV = BEG;
9410 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9411 ZV = Z;
9412 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9413 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9415 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9416 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9417 if (multibyte
9418 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9420 ptrdiff_t i;
9421 int c, char_bytes;
9422 char work[1];
9424 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9425 for the *Message* buffer. */
9426 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9428 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9429 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9431 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9432 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9435 else if (! multibyte
9436 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9438 ptrdiff_t i;
9439 int c, char_bytes;
9440 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9441 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9442 for the *Message* buffer. */
9443 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9445 c = msg[i];
9446 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9447 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9448 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9451 else if (nbytes)
9452 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9454 if (nlflag)
9456 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9457 printmax_t dups;
9458 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9460 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9461 this_bol = PT;
9462 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9464 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9465 If so, combine duplicates. */
9466 if (this_bol > BEG)
9468 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9469 prev_bol = PT;
9470 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9472 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9473 this_bol_byte);
9474 if (dups)
9476 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9477 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9478 if (dups > 1)
9480 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9481 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9483 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9484 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9485 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9486 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9487 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9492 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9493 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9494 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9496 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9498 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9499 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9500 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9503 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9504 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9506 if (zv_at_end)
9508 ZV = Z;
9509 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9511 else
9513 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9514 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9517 if (point_at_end)
9518 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9519 else
9520 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9521 Lisp code. */
9522 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9523 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9525 UNGCPRO;
9526 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9527 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9528 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9530 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9531 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9532 if (NILP (tem))
9533 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9534 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9535 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9540 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9541 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9542 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9543 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9544 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9546 static intmax_t
9547 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9549 ptrdiff_t i;
9550 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9551 int seen_dots = 0;
9552 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9553 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9555 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9557 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9558 seen_dots = 1;
9559 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9560 return seen_dots;
9562 p1 += len;
9563 if (*p1 == '\n')
9564 return 2;
9565 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9567 char *pend;
9568 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9569 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9570 return n+1;
9572 return 0;
9576 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9577 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9578 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9579 through.
9581 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9583 void
9584 message2 (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9586 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9587 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9588 if (m)
9589 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9590 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9594 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9596 void
9597 message2_nolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9599 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9600 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9602 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9604 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9605 putc ('\n', stderr);
9606 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9607 if (m)
9608 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9609 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9610 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9611 fflush (stderr);
9613 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9614 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9615 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9616 else if (INTERACTIVE
9617 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9618 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9620 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9621 struct frame *f;
9623 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9624 that the selected frame is using. */
9625 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9626 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9628 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9629 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9630 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9631 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9633 if (m)
9635 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9636 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9637 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9639 else
9640 clear_message (1, 1);
9642 do_pending_window_change (0);
9643 echo_area_display (1);
9644 do_pending_window_change (0);
9645 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
9646 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9651 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9652 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9653 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9654 text show through.
9656 This function cancels echoing. */
9658 void
9659 message3 (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9661 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9663 GCPRO1 (m);
9664 clear_message (1,1);
9665 cancel_echoing ();
9667 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9668 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9669 if (STRINGP (m))
9671 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9672 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9673 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9674 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9675 SAFE_FREE ();
9677 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9679 UNGCPRO;
9683 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9684 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9685 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9686 and make this cancel echoing. */
9688 void
9689 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9691 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9692 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9694 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9696 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9697 putc ('\n', stderr);
9698 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9699 if (STRINGP (m))
9700 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9701 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9702 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9703 fflush (stderr);
9705 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9706 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9707 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9708 else if (INTERACTIVE
9709 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9710 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9712 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9713 Lisp_Object frame;
9714 struct frame *f;
9716 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9717 that the selected frame is using. */
9718 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9719 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9720 f = XFRAME (frame);
9722 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9723 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9724 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9725 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9727 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9729 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9730 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9731 Fraise_frame (frame);
9732 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9733 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9734 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9736 else
9737 clear_message (1, 1);
9739 do_pending_window_change (0);
9740 echo_area_display (1);
9741 do_pending_window_change (0);
9742 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
9743 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9748 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9749 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9751 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9752 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9753 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9754 that was alloca'd. */
9756 void
9757 message1 (const char *m)
9759 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9763 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9765 void
9766 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9768 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9771 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9772 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9774 void
9775 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9777 CHECK_STRING (string);
9779 if (noninteractive)
9781 if (m)
9783 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9784 putc ('\n', stderr);
9785 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9786 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9787 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9788 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9789 fflush (stderr);
9792 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9794 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9795 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9796 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9797 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9798 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9800 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9801 that the selected frame is using. */
9802 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9803 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9805 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9806 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9807 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9808 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9810 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9811 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9813 args[0] = build_string (m);
9814 args[1] = msg = string;
9815 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9816 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9818 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9820 if (log)
9821 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9822 else
9823 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9825 UNGCPRO;
9827 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9828 buffer next time. */
9829 message_buf_print = 0;
9835 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9836 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9838 static void
9839 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9841 if (noninteractive)
9843 if (m)
9845 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9846 putc ('\n', stderr);
9847 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9848 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9849 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9850 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9851 fflush (stderr);
9854 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9856 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9857 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9858 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9859 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9860 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9862 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9863 that the selected frame is using. */
9864 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9865 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9867 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9868 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9869 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9870 it. */
9871 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9873 if (m)
9875 ptrdiff_t len;
9877 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9878 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9880 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 1);
9882 else
9883 message1 (0);
9885 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9886 buffer next time. */
9887 message_buf_print = 0;
9892 void
9893 message (const char *m, ...)
9895 va_list ap;
9896 va_start (ap, m);
9897 vmessage (m, ap);
9898 va_end (ap);
9902 #if 0
9903 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9905 void
9906 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9908 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9909 va_list ap;
9910 va_start (ap, m);
9911 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9912 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9913 vmessage (m, ap);
9914 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9915 va_end (ap);
9917 #endif
9920 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9921 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9922 critical. */
9924 void
9925 update_echo_area (void)
9927 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9929 Lisp_Object string;
9930 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9931 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9932 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9937 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9938 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9940 static void
9941 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9943 int i;
9945 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9946 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9947 || !BUFFER_LIVE_P (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])))
9949 char name[30];
9950 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9951 int j;
9953 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9954 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
9955 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
9956 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
9957 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9958 it was decided to postpone this*/
9959 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9961 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9962 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9963 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9968 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9969 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9971 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9972 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9973 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9975 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9976 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9978 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9979 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9980 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9982 Value is what FN returns. */
9984 static int
9985 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9986 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
9987 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
9989 Lisp_Object buffer;
9990 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9991 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9993 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9994 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9996 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9998 if (which == 0)
9999 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10000 else if (which > 0)
10001 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
10002 else
10004 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
10005 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10007 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
10008 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
10009 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
10010 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
10011 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
10014 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
10015 have one. */
10016 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
10018 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
10019 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
10020 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
10021 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
10022 clear_buffer_p = 1;
10025 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
10027 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
10028 for a different purpose. */
10029 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
10030 cancel_echoing ();
10032 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
10033 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
10035 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10036 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10037 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10038 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10039 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10040 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10041 aborts. */
10042 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10043 if (w)
10045 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10046 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10049 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10050 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10051 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10052 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10054 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10055 del_range (BEG, Z);
10057 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10058 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10060 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
10062 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10063 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10065 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10066 return rc;
10070 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10071 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10073 static Lisp_Object
10074 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10076 int i = 0;
10077 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10079 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10080 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10081 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10082 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10084 if (NILP (vector))
10085 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
10087 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10088 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10089 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10091 if (w)
10093 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10094 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
10095 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
10096 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
10098 else
10100 int end = i + 4;
10101 for (; i < end; ++i)
10102 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10105 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10106 return vector;
10110 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10111 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10113 static Lisp_Object
10114 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10116 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10117 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10118 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10120 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10122 struct window *w;
10123 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
10125 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10126 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10127 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
10128 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
10130 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10131 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10132 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
10135 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10136 return Qnil;
10140 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10141 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10143 void
10144 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10146 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10147 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10148 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10150 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10152 if (!message_buf_print)
10154 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10155 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10156 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10157 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10158 else
10159 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10161 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10162 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10163 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10165 if (Z > BEG)
10167 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10168 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10169 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10170 del_range (BEG, Z);
10171 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10173 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10175 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10176 if (multibyte_p
10177 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10178 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10180 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10181 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10183 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10184 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10185 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10186 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10189 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10190 message_buf_print = 1;
10192 else
10194 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10196 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10197 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10198 else
10199 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10202 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10204 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10205 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10206 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10212 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10213 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10214 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10215 display the current message. */
10217 static int
10218 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10220 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10222 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10223 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10224 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10225 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10226 redisplay. */
10227 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10229 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10230 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10231 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10232 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10233 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10234 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10236 window_height_changed_p
10237 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10238 display_echo_area_1,
10239 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
10241 if (no_message_p)
10242 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10244 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10245 return window_height_changed_p;
10249 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10250 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10251 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10252 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10253 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10255 static int
10256 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10258 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10259 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10260 Lisp_Object window;
10261 struct text_pos start;
10262 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10264 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10265 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10266 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10267 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10269 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10270 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10272 /* Display. */
10273 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10274 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10275 try_window (window, start, 0);
10277 return window_height_changed_p;
10281 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10282 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10283 is active, don't shrink it. */
10285 void
10286 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10288 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10289 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10291 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10292 int resized_p;
10293 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
10295 if (minibuf_level == 0)
10296 resize_exactly = Qt;
10297 else
10298 resize_exactly = Qnil;
10300 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10301 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
10302 0, 0);
10303 if (resized_p)
10305 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10306 ++update_mode_lines;
10307 redisplay_internal ();
10313 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10314 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10315 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10316 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10317 resize_mini_window returns. */
10319 static int
10320 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10322 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10323 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10327 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10328 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10329 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10331 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10332 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10333 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10334 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10336 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10339 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10341 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10342 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10344 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10346 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10347 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10348 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10349 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10351 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10352 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10353 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10354 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10355 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10356 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10357 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10358 return 0;
10360 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10361 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10362 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10363 return 0;
10365 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10367 struct it it;
10368 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10369 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10370 int height;
10371 EMACS_INT max_height;
10372 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10373 struct text_pos start;
10374 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10376 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10378 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10379 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10382 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10384 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10385 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10386 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10387 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10388 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10389 else
10390 max_height = total_height / 4;
10392 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10393 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10394 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10396 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10397 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10398 height = 1;
10399 else
10401 last_height = 0;
10402 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10403 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10404 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10405 else
10406 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10407 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10408 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10411 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10412 if (height > max_height)
10414 height = max_height;
10415 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10416 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10417 start = it.current.pos;
10419 else
10420 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10421 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10423 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10425 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10426 case the window shrinks again. */
10427 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10429 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10430 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10431 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10432 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10434 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10435 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10437 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10438 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10439 shrink_mini_window (w);
10440 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10443 else
10445 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10446 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10448 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10449 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10450 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10451 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10453 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10455 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10456 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10457 shrink_mini_window (w);
10459 if (height)
10461 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10462 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10465 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10469 if (old_current_buffer)
10470 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10473 return window_height_changed_p;
10477 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10478 current message. */
10480 Lisp_Object
10481 current_message (void)
10483 Lisp_Object msg;
10485 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10486 msg = Qnil;
10487 else
10489 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10490 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10491 if (NILP (msg))
10492 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10495 return msg;
10499 static int
10500 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10502 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10503 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10505 if (Z > BEG)
10506 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10507 else
10508 *msg = Qnil;
10509 return 0;
10513 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10514 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10515 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10516 worth optimizing. */
10518 bool
10519 push_message (void)
10521 Lisp_Object msg = current_message ();
10522 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10523 return STRINGP (msg);
10527 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10529 void
10530 restore_message (void)
10532 Lisp_Object msg;
10534 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10535 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10536 if (STRINGP (msg))
10537 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10538 else
10539 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10543 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10545 Lisp_Object
10546 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10548 pop_message ();
10549 return Qnil;
10552 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10554 static void
10555 pop_message (void)
10557 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10558 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10562 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10563 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10564 somewhere. */
10566 void
10567 check_message_stack (void)
10569 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10570 emacs_abort ();
10574 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10575 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10577 void
10578 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10580 if (nchars == 0)
10581 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10582 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10583 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10584 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10585 else if (!noninteractive
10586 && INTERACTIVE
10587 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10589 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10590 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10591 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10596 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10597 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10599 static int
10600 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10602 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10603 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10604 if (Z == BEG)
10605 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10606 return 0;
10609 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10611 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10612 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10613 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10615 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10616 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10617 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10619 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10620 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10623 static void
10624 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10625 ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10627 message_enable_multibyte
10628 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10629 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10631 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10632 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10633 message_buf_print = 0;
10634 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10636 if (STRINGP (Vdebug_on_message)
10637 && fast_string_match (Vdebug_on_message, string) >= 0)
10638 call_debugger (list2 (Qerror, string));
10642 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10643 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10644 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10645 current. */
10647 static int
10648 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t nbytes, ptrdiff_t multibyte_p)
10650 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10651 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10652 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10653 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10655 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10656 if (message_enable_multibyte
10657 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10658 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10660 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10661 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10662 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10664 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10665 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10667 if (STRINGP (string))
10669 ptrdiff_t nchars;
10671 if (nbytes == 0)
10672 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10673 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10675 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10676 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10677 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10678 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10680 else if (s)
10682 if (nbytes == 0)
10683 nbytes = strlen (s);
10685 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10687 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10688 ptrdiff_t i;
10689 int c, n;
10690 char work[1];
10692 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10693 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10695 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10696 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10698 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10699 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10702 else if (!multibyte_p
10703 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10705 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10706 ptrdiff_t i;
10707 int c, n;
10708 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10710 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10711 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10713 c = msg[i];
10714 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10715 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10716 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10719 else
10720 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10723 return 0;
10727 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10728 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10729 last displayed. */
10731 void
10732 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10734 if (current_p)
10736 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10737 message_cleared_p = 1;
10740 if (last_displayed_p)
10741 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10743 message_buf_print = 0;
10746 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10748 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10749 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10750 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10751 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10752 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10753 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10755 static void
10756 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10758 if (frame_garbaged)
10760 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10761 int changed_count = 0;
10763 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10765 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10767 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10769 if (f->resized_p)
10771 redraw_frame (f);
10772 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10774 clear_current_matrices (f);
10775 changed_count++;
10776 f->garbaged = 0;
10777 f->resized_p = 0;
10781 frame_garbaged = 0;
10782 if (changed_count)
10783 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10788 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10789 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10790 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10792 static int
10793 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10795 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10796 struct window *w;
10797 struct frame *f;
10798 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10799 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10801 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10802 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10803 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10805 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10806 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10807 return 0;
10809 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10810 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10811 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10812 the terminal. */
10813 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10814 return 0;
10815 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10817 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10818 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10820 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10822 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10823 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10824 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10826 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10827 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10828 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10829 here could cause confusion. */
10830 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10832 int n = 0;
10834 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10835 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10836 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10837 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10838 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10839 if (!display_completed)
10840 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10842 if (window_height_changed_p
10843 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10844 needs to run hooks. */
10845 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10847 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10848 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10849 pending input. */
10850 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10851 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10852 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10853 redisplay_internal ();
10854 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10856 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10858 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10859 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10860 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10861 update_single_window (w, 1);
10862 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10864 else
10865 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10867 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10868 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10869 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10870 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10871 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10874 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10875 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10877 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10878 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10879 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10880 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10882 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10883 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10884 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10885 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10886 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10888 return window_height_changed_p;
10891 /* Nonzero if the current window's buffer is shown in more than one
10892 window and was modified since last redisplay. */
10894 static int
10895 buffer_shared_and_changed (void)
10897 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
10898 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. */
10899 return (buffer_shared > 1 && UNCHANGED_MODIFIED < MODIFF);
10902 /* Nonzero if W doesn't reflect the actual state of current buffer due
10903 to its text or overlays change. FIXME: this may be called when
10904 XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer, which looks suspicious. */
10906 static int
10907 window_outdated (struct window *w)
10909 return (w->last_modified < MODIFF
10910 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF);
10913 /* Nonzero if W's buffer was changed but not saved or Transient Mark mode
10914 is enabled and mark of W's buffer was changed since last W's update. */
10916 static int
10917 window_buffer_changed (struct window *w)
10919 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
10921 eassert (BUFFER_LIVE_P (b));
10923 return (((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b) < BUF_MODIFF (b)) != w->last_had_star)
10924 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode) && !NILP (BVAR (b, mark_active)))
10925 != !NILP (w->region_showing)));
10928 /* Nonzero if W has %c in its mode line and mode line should be updated. */
10930 static int
10931 mode_line_update_needed (struct window *w)
10933 return (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
10934 && !(PT == w->last_point && !window_outdated (w))
10935 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()));
10938 /***********************************************************************
10939 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10940 ***********************************************************************/
10942 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10943 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10944 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10946 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10948 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10950 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10951 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10953 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10954 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10956 static enum {
10957 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10958 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10959 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10960 MODE_LINE_STRING
10961 } mode_line_target;
10963 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10964 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10965 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10967 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10968 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10970 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10971 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10972 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10975 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10977 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10979 static Lisp_Object
10980 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
10981 struct buffer *obuf,
10982 Lisp_Object owin,
10983 int save_proptrans)
10985 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10987 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10988 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10989 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10990 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10992 if (NILP (vector))
10993 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
10995 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10996 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10997 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10998 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10999 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
11000 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
11002 if (obuf)
11003 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
11004 else
11005 tmp = Qnil;
11006 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
11007 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
11008 if (target_frame)
11010 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
11011 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
11012 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
11013 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
11014 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
11015 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
11018 return vector;
11021 static Lisp_Object
11022 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
11024 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
11025 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
11026 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
11028 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
11029 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
11030 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
11031 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
11032 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
11033 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
11034 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
11036 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
11037 if (!NILP (old_window))
11039 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
11040 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
11041 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
11042 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
11044 Lisp_Object frame
11045 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
11047 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
11048 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
11050 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
11051 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
11054 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
11057 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
11059 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
11060 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
11063 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
11064 return Qnil;
11068 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
11069 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
11071 static void
11072 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
11074 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
11075 increase the buffer's size. */
11076 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
11078 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11079 ptrdiff_t size = len;
11080 mode_line_noprop_buf =
11081 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11082 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11083 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11086 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11090 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11091 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11092 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11093 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11094 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11095 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11096 frame title. */
11098 static int
11099 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11101 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11102 int n = 0;
11103 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11105 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11106 nbytes = strlen (string);
11107 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11108 while (nbytes--)
11109 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11111 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11112 while (field_width > 0
11113 && n < field_width)
11115 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11116 ++n;
11119 return n;
11122 /***********************************************************************
11123 Frame Titles
11124 ***********************************************************************/
11126 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11128 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11129 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11130 frame_title_format. */
11132 static void
11133 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11135 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11137 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11138 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11139 || f->explicit_name)
11141 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11142 Lisp_Object tail, other_frame, fmt;
11143 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11144 char *title;
11145 ptrdiff_t len;
11146 struct it it;
11147 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11149 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, other_frame)
11151 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11153 if (tf != f
11154 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11155 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11156 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11157 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11158 break;
11161 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11162 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11164 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11165 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11166 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11167 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11168 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11169 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11171 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11172 set_buffer_internal_1
11173 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11174 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11176 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11177 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11178 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11179 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11180 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11181 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11182 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11183 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11185 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11186 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11187 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11188 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11189 higher level than this.) */
11190 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11191 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11192 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11193 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11197 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11200 /***********************************************************************
11201 Menu Bars
11202 ***********************************************************************/
11205 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11206 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11208 void
11209 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11211 int all_windows;
11212 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11213 struct frame *f;
11214 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11216 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11217 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11218 #else
11219 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11220 #endif
11222 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11223 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11224 up-to-date frame titles. */
11225 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11226 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
11228 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11230 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11232 f = XFRAME (frame);
11233 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11234 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
11235 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11238 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11240 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11241 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11242 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
11243 || buffer_shared_and_changed ()
11244 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
11245 if (all_windows)
11247 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11248 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11249 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11250 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11251 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11253 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11255 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11257 f = XFRAME (frame);
11259 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11260 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11261 continue;
11263 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11264 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11265 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11267 Lisp_Object functions;
11269 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11270 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11271 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11272 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11274 while (CONSP (functions))
11276 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11277 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11278 functions = XCDR (functions);
11280 UNGCPRO;
11283 GCPRO1 (tail);
11284 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11285 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11286 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11287 #endif
11288 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11289 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11290 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11291 ns_set_doc_edited
11292 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11293 #endif
11294 UNGCPRO;
11297 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11299 else
11301 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11302 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11303 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11304 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11305 #endif
11310 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11311 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11312 eval.
11314 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11316 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11317 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11318 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11319 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11321 static int
11322 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11324 Lisp_Object window;
11325 register struct window *w;
11327 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11328 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11329 redisplay. */
11330 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11331 return hooks_run;
11333 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11334 w = XWINDOW (window);
11336 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11338 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11339 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11340 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11341 #else
11342 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11343 #endif
11344 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11346 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11347 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11348 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11349 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11350 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11351 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11352 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11353 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11354 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11355 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11356 || update_mode_lines
11357 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11359 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11360 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11362 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11364 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11365 if (save_match_data)
11366 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11367 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11369 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11370 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11373 if (!hooks_run)
11375 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11376 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11378 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11379 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11380 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11381 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11383 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11385 hooks_run = 1;
11388 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11389 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11391 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11392 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11393 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11394 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11396 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11397 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11398 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11399 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11400 #endif
11401 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11403 else
11404 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11405 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11406 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11407 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11408 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11409 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11410 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11411 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11413 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11414 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11418 return hooks_run;
11423 /***********************************************************************
11424 Output Cursor
11425 ***********************************************************************/
11427 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11429 /* EXPORT:
11430 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11431 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11432 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11434 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11437 /* EXPORT:
11438 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11439 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11441 void
11442 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11444 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11445 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11446 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11447 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11451 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11452 Set a nominal cursor position.
11454 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11455 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11457 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11458 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11459 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11460 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11462 void
11463 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11465 struct window *w;
11467 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11468 if (updated_window)
11469 w = updated_window;
11470 else
11471 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11473 /* Set the output cursor. */
11474 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11475 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11476 output_cursor.x = x;
11477 output_cursor.y = y;
11479 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11480 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11481 if (updated_window == NULL)
11483 block_input ();
11484 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11485 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11486 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11487 unblock_input ();
11491 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11494 /***********************************************************************
11495 Tool-bars
11496 ***********************************************************************/
11498 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11500 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11502 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11504 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11505 or -1. */
11507 int last_tool_bar_item;
11509 /* Select `frame' temporarily without running all the code in
11510 do_switch_frame.
11511 FIXME: Maybe do_switch_frame should be trimmed down similarly
11512 when `norecord' is set. */
11513 static Lisp_Object
11514 fast_set_selected_frame (Lisp_Object frame)
11516 if (!EQ (selected_frame, frame))
11518 selected_frame = frame;
11519 selected_window = XFRAME (frame)->selected_window;
11521 return Qnil;
11524 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11525 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11526 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11527 and restore it here. */
11529 static void
11530 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11532 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11533 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11534 #else
11535 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11536 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11537 #endif
11539 if (do_update)
11541 Lisp_Object window;
11542 struct window *w;
11544 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11545 w = XWINDOW (window);
11547 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11548 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11549 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11550 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11551 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11552 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11553 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11554 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11555 || w->update_mode_line
11556 || update_mode_lines
11557 || window_buffer_changed (w))
11559 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11560 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11561 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11562 int new_n_tool_bar;
11563 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11565 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11566 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11567 keymaps. */
11568 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11570 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11571 if (save_match_data)
11572 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11574 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11575 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11577 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11578 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11581 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11583 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11584 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11585 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11586 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11587 eassert (EQ (selected_window,
11588 /* Since we only explicitly preserve selected_frame,
11589 check that selected_window would be redundant. */
11590 XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window));
11591 record_unwind_protect (fast_set_selected_frame, selected_frame);
11592 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11593 fast_set_selected_frame (frame);
11595 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11596 new_tool_bar
11597 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11598 &new_n_tool_bar);
11600 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11601 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11602 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11604 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11605 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11606 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11607 block_input ();
11608 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11609 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11610 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11611 unblock_input ();
11614 UNGCPRO;
11616 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11617 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11623 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11624 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11625 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11627 static void
11628 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11630 int i, size, size_needed;
11631 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11632 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11634 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11635 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11637 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11638 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11640 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11641 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11642 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11643 : 0);
11645 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11646 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11648 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11649 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11650 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11651 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11652 else
11654 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11655 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11656 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11659 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11660 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11661 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11662 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11664 #define PROP(IDX) \
11665 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11667 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11668 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11669 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11671 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11672 button state. */
11673 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11674 if (VECTORP (image))
11676 if (enabled_p)
11677 idx = (selected_p
11678 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11679 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11680 else
11681 idx = (selected_p
11682 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11683 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11685 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11686 image = AREF (image, idx);
11688 else
11689 idx = -1;
11691 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11692 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11693 continue;
11695 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11696 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11698 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11699 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11700 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11701 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11702 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11704 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11705 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11707 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11708 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11710 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11712 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11713 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11714 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11716 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11717 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11718 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11721 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11723 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11724 selected. */
11725 if (selected_p)
11727 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11728 hmargin -= relief;
11729 vmargin -= relief;
11732 else
11734 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11735 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11736 raised relief. */
11737 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11738 (selected_p
11739 ? make_number (-relief)
11740 : make_number (relief)));
11741 hmargin -= relief;
11742 vmargin -= relief;
11745 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11746 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11748 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11749 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11750 else
11751 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11752 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11753 make_number (vmargin)));
11756 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11757 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11758 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11759 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11760 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11762 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11763 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11764 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11765 vector. */
11766 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11767 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11768 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11770 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11771 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11772 previous string. */
11773 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11774 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11775 else
11776 end = i + 1;
11777 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11778 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11779 #undef PROP
11782 UNGCPRO;
11786 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11788 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11789 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11790 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11791 vertically in the new height.
11793 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11794 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11795 the window width.
11798 static void
11799 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11801 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11802 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11803 struct glyph *last;
11805 prepare_desired_row (row);
11806 row->y = it->current_y;
11808 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11809 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11810 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11812 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11814 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11815 struct it it_before;
11817 /* Get the next display element. */
11818 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11820 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11821 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11822 return;
11823 break;
11826 /* Produce glyphs. */
11827 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11828 it_before = *it;
11830 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11832 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11833 i = 0;
11834 x = it_before.current_x;
11835 while (i < nglyphs)
11837 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11839 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11841 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11842 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11843 *it = it_before;
11844 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11845 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11846 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11847 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11848 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11849 break;
11850 goto out;
11853 ++it->hpos;
11854 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11855 ++i;
11858 /* Stop at line end. */
11859 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11860 break;
11862 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11865 out:;
11867 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11869 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11871 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11872 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11873 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11874 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11875 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11876 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11878 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11879 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11880 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11881 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11882 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11884 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11885 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11887 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11888 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11889 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11890 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11893 compute_line_metrics (it);
11895 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11896 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11898 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11899 row->visible_height = row->height;
11900 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11901 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11904 row->full_width_p = 1;
11905 row->continued_p = 0;
11906 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11907 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11909 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11910 it->current_y += row->height;
11911 ++it->vpos;
11912 ++it->glyph_row;
11916 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11918 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11919 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11921 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11922 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11923 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11925 static int
11926 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11928 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11929 struct it it;
11930 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11931 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11932 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11933 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11935 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11936 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11937 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11938 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11939 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11940 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11941 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11943 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11945 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11946 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11947 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11949 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11951 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11952 if (n_rows)
11953 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11955 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11959 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11960 0, 1, 0,
11961 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME.
11962 If FRAME is nil or omitted, use the selected frame. */)
11963 (Lisp_Object frame)
11965 struct frame *f = decode_any_frame (frame);
11966 struct window *w;
11967 int nlines = 0;
11969 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11970 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11971 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11973 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11974 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11976 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11977 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11981 return make_number (nlines);
11985 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11986 height should be changed. */
11988 static int
11989 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11991 struct window *w;
11992 struct it it;
11993 struct glyph_row *row;
11995 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11996 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11997 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11998 return 0;
11999 #endif
12001 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
12002 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
12003 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
12004 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
12005 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
12006 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
12007 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
12008 return 0;
12010 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
12011 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
12012 it.first_visible_x = 0;
12013 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
12014 row = it.glyph_row;
12016 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
12017 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
12018 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
12019 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
12020 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
12021 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
12022 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
12023 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
12024 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
12025 do. */
12026 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
12028 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
12030 int nlines;
12032 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
12033 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
12035 Lisp_Object frame;
12036 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12038 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12039 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12040 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12041 make_number (nlines)),
12042 Qnil));
12043 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12045 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12046 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12047 return 1;
12052 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
12054 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
12056 int border, rows, height, extra;
12058 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
12059 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
12060 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
12061 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
12062 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
12063 border = f->border_width;
12064 else
12065 border = 0;
12066 if (border < 0)
12067 border = 0;
12069 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
12070 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
12071 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
12073 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12075 int h = 0;
12076 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12078 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12079 extra -= h;
12081 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12084 else
12086 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12087 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12090 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12091 window, so don't do it. */
12092 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12093 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12095 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12097 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12098 int change_height_p = 0;
12100 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12101 height if there is room for more. */
12102 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12103 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12104 change_height_p = 1;
12106 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12108 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12109 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12110 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12111 if (!row->displays_text_p
12112 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12113 change_height_p = 1;
12115 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12116 change the tool-bar's height. */
12117 if (row->displays_text_p
12118 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12119 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12120 change_height_p = 1;
12122 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12123 frame parameter. */
12124 if (change_height_p)
12126 Lisp_Object frame;
12127 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12128 int nrows;
12129 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
12131 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12132 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12133 ? (nlines > old_height)
12134 : (nlines != old_height));
12135 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12137 if (change_height_p)
12139 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12140 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12141 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12142 make_number (nlines)),
12143 Qnil));
12144 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12146 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12147 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12148 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12149 return 1;
12155 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12156 return 0;
12160 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12161 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12162 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12163 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12165 static int
12166 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12168 Lisp_Object prop;
12169 int success_p;
12170 int charpos;
12172 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12173 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12174 error. */
12175 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12176 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12178 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12179 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12180 F->tool_bar_items. */
12181 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12182 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12183 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12185 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12186 success_p = 1;
12188 else
12189 success_p = 0;
12191 return success_p;
12195 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12196 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12197 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12198 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12199 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12201 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12202 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12203 1 otherwise. */
12205 static int
12206 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12207 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12209 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12210 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12211 int area;
12213 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12214 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12215 if (*glyph == NULL)
12216 return -1;
12218 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12219 f->tool_bar_items. */
12220 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12221 return -1;
12223 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12224 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12225 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12226 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12227 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12228 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12229 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12230 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12231 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12232 return 0;
12234 return 1;
12238 /* EXPORT:
12239 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12240 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12241 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12242 release. */
12244 void
12245 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12246 int modifiers)
12248 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12249 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12250 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12251 struct glyph *glyph;
12252 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12254 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
12255 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12256 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
12257 return;
12259 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12260 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12261 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12262 return;
12264 if (down_p)
12266 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12267 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12268 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
12269 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12271 else
12273 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12274 struct input_event event;
12275 EVENT_INIT (event);
12277 /* Show item in released state. */
12278 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12279 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12281 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12283 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12284 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12285 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12286 event.arg = frame;
12287 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12289 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12290 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12291 event.arg = key;
12292 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12293 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12294 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12299 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12300 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12301 note_mouse_highlight. */
12303 static void
12304 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12306 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12307 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12308 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12309 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12310 int hpos, vpos;
12311 struct glyph *glyph;
12312 struct glyph_row *row;
12313 int i;
12314 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12315 int prop_idx;
12316 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12317 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12319 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12320 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12321 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12323 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12324 return;
12327 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12328 if (rc < 0)
12330 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12331 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12332 return;
12334 else if (rc == 0)
12335 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12336 goto set_help_echo;
12338 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12340 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12341 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
12342 && f == last_mouse_frame
12343 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
12344 if (mouse_down_p
12345 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12346 return;
12348 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12349 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12351 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12352 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12353 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
12355 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12356 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12357 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12358 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12359 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12361 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12362 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12363 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12364 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12365 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
12366 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12368 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12369 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12370 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12371 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
12372 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12373 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12375 /* Display it as active. */
12376 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12377 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
12380 set_help_echo:
12382 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12383 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12384 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12385 help_echo_pos = -1;
12386 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12387 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12388 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12391 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12395 /************************************************************************
12396 Horizontal scrolling
12397 ************************************************************************/
12399 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12400 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12402 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12403 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12404 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12405 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12406 changed. */
12408 static int
12409 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12411 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12412 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12413 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12414 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12416 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12418 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12419 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12421 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12422 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12425 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12427 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12428 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12429 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12431 else
12432 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12434 while (WINDOWP (window))
12436 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12438 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12439 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12440 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12441 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12442 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12444 int h_margin;
12445 int text_area_width;
12446 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12447 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12448 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12449 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12450 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12451 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12452 ? desired_cursor_row
12453 : current_cursor_row);
12454 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12456 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12458 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12459 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12461 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12462 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12463 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12464 inside the left margin and the window is already
12465 hscrolled. */
12466 && ((!row_r2l_p
12467 && ((w->hscroll
12468 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12469 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12470 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12471 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12472 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12473 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12474 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12475 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12476 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12477 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12478 || (row_r2l_p
12479 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12480 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12481 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12482 are actually truncated on the left. */
12483 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12484 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12485 || (w->hscroll
12486 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12488 struct it it;
12489 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12490 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12491 ptrdiff_t pt;
12492 int wanted_x;
12494 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12495 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12496 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12498 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12499 pt = PT;
12500 else
12502 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12503 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12504 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12507 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12508 a line with infinite width. */
12509 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12510 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12511 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12512 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12514 /* Position cursor in window. */
12515 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12516 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12517 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12518 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12519 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12520 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12521 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12522 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12523 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12525 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12526 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12527 - h_margin;
12528 else
12529 wanted_x = text_area_width
12530 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12531 - h_margin;
12532 hscroll
12533 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12535 else
12537 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12538 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12539 + h_margin;
12540 else
12541 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12542 + h_margin;
12543 hscroll
12544 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12546 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12548 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12549 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12550 redisplay. */
12551 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12553 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12554 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12555 hscrolled_p = 1;
12560 window = w->next;
12563 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12564 return hscrolled_p;
12568 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12569 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12570 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12571 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12572 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12574 static int
12575 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12577 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12578 if (hscrolled_p)
12579 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12580 return hscrolled_p;
12585 /************************************************************************
12586 Redisplay
12587 ************************************************************************/
12589 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12590 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12591 session. */
12593 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12595 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12597 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12598 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12600 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12602 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12604 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12606 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12608 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12609 try_window_id. */
12611 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12613 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12614 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12615 resulting string to stderr. */
12617 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12618 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12620 static void
12621 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12623 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12624 int len = strlen (method);
12625 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12626 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12627 va_list ap;
12629 if (len && remaining)
12631 method[len] = '|';
12632 --remaining, ++len;
12635 va_start (ap, fmt);
12636 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12637 va_end (ap);
12639 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12640 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12642 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12643 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12644 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12645 : "no buffer"),
12646 method + len);
12649 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12652 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12653 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12654 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12655 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12657 static int
12658 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12659 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12661 int unchanged_p = 1;
12663 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12664 if (window_outdated (w))
12666 /* Gap in the line? */
12667 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12668 unchanged_p = 0;
12670 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12671 if (unchanged_p
12672 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12673 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12674 unchanged_p = 0;
12676 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12677 beginning of the line. */
12678 if (unchanged_p
12679 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12680 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12681 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12682 unchanged_p = 0;
12684 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12685 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12686 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12687 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12688 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12689 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12690 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12691 if (unchanged_p)
12693 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12694 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12695 unchanged_p = 0;
12696 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12697 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12698 unchanged_p = 0;
12701 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12702 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12703 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12704 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12705 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12706 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12707 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12708 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12709 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12710 unchanged_p = 0;
12713 return unchanged_p;
12717 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12718 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12720 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12721 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12722 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12724 void
12725 redisplay (void)
12727 redisplay_internal ();
12731 static Lisp_Object
12732 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12734 Lisp_Object val;
12736 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12737 return val;
12739 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12742 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12743 static int
12744 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12746 Lisp_Object vlist;
12748 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12749 CONSP (vlist);
12750 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12752 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12753 Lisp_Object val;
12755 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12756 continue;
12757 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12758 if (MARKERP (val)
12759 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12760 return 1;
12762 return 0;
12766 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12767 has changed. */
12769 static int
12770 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12772 Lisp_Object vlist;
12774 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12775 CONSP (vlist);
12776 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12778 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12779 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12781 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12782 continue;
12783 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12784 if (!MARKERP (val))
12785 continue;
12786 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12787 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12788 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12789 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12790 return 1;
12792 return 0;
12795 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12797 static void
12798 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12800 Lisp_Object vlist;
12802 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12803 CONSP (vlist);
12804 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12806 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12808 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12809 continue;
12811 if (up_to_date > 0)
12813 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12814 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12815 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12816 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12817 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12819 else if (up_to_date < 0
12820 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12822 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12823 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12829 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12830 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12831 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12833 static Lisp_Object
12834 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12836 Lisp_Object vlist;
12838 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12839 CONSP (vlist);
12840 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12842 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12843 Lisp_Object val;
12845 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12846 continue;
12848 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12850 if (MARKERP (val)
12851 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12852 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12854 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12855 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12856 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12857 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12859 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12860 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12862 int fringe_bitmap;
12863 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12864 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12866 #endif
12867 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap. */
12869 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12873 return Qnil;
12876 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12877 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12878 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12880 static int
12881 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
12882 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
12884 ptrdiff_t start, end;
12885 Lisp_Object prop;
12886 Lisp_Object buffer;
12888 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12889 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12890 same buffer. */
12891 if (prev_buf == buf)
12893 if (prev_pt == pt)
12894 /* Point didn't move. */
12895 return 0;
12897 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12898 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12899 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12900 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12901 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12902 point moved out of the composition. */
12903 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12906 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12907 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12908 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12909 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12910 && start < pt && end > pt);
12914 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12915 in window W. */
12917 static void
12918 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12920 if (b->clip_changed
12921 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12922 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12923 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12924 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12925 b->clip_changed = 0;
12927 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12928 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12929 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12930 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12931 check. */
12932 if (!b->clip_changed
12933 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12935 ptrdiff_t pt;
12937 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12938 pt = PT;
12939 else
12940 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12942 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12943 || pt != w->last_point)
12944 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12945 w->last_point,
12946 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12947 b->clip_changed = 1;
12952 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12953 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12954 directly. */
12956 static void
12957 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12959 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12960 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12961 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12963 eassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12965 selected_frame = frame;
12967 do {
12968 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist;
12969 CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12970 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12971 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12972 SYMBOLP (tem))
12973 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12974 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12975 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12976 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12977 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12978 find_symbol_value (tem);
12979 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12982 /* Make sure that previously selected OLD_FRAME is selected unless it has been
12983 deleted (by an X connection failure during redisplay, for example). */
12985 static void
12986 ensure_selected_frame (Lisp_Object old_frame)
12988 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
12989 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
12992 #define STOP_POLLING \
12993 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12994 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12996 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12997 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12998 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
13001 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
13002 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
13004 static void
13005 redisplay_internal (void)
13007 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
13008 struct window *sw;
13009 struct frame *fr;
13010 int pending;
13011 int must_finish = 0;
13012 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
13013 int number_of_visible_frames;
13014 ptrdiff_t count, count1;
13015 struct frame *sf;
13016 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
13017 Lisp_Object tail, frame, old_frame = selected_frame;
13018 struct backtrace backtrace;
13020 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
13021 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
13022 int consider_all_windows_p;
13024 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow. */
13025 int update_miniwindow_p = 0;
13027 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
13029 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
13030 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
13031 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
13032 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
13033 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
13034 return;
13036 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
13037 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
13038 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
13039 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
13040 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
13042 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
13043 return;
13045 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
13046 if (popup_activated ())
13047 return;
13048 #endif
13050 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
13051 if (redisplaying_p)
13052 return;
13054 /* Record a function that clears redisplaying_p
13055 when we leave this function. */
13056 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13057 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay, selected_frame);
13058 redisplaying_p = 1;
13059 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
13061 /* Record this function, so it appears on the profiler's backtraces. */
13062 backtrace.next = backtrace_list;
13063 backtrace.function = Qredisplay_internal;
13064 backtrace.args = &Qnil;
13065 backtrace.nargs = 0;
13066 backtrace.debug_on_exit = 0;
13067 backtrace_list = &backtrace;
13069 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13070 XFRAME (frame)->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
13072 retry:
13073 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
13074 sw = w;
13076 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
13077 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
13078 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
13079 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
13080 ensure_selected_frame (old_frame);
13082 pending = 0;
13083 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13084 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13085 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13086 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13087 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13089 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
13090 necessary, do it. */
13091 if (fonts_changed_p)
13093 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
13094 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13095 fonts_changed_p = 0;
13098 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13099 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13100 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13101 if (face_change_count)
13102 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13104 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13105 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13107 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13108 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13109 the whole thing. */
13110 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13111 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13112 #ifndef DOS_NT
13113 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13114 #endif
13115 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13118 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking for
13119 resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames are
13120 visible. See the comment in frame.h for FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13121 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13123 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13125 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13127 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13128 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13129 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13130 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13133 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13134 do_pending_window_change (1);
13136 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13137 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13138 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13140 sw = w;
13141 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13144 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13145 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13147 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13148 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13149 prepare_menu_bars ();
13151 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
13152 update_mode_lines++;
13154 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13155 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13157 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13158 if (buffer_shared_and_changed ())
13159 update_mode_lines++;
13162 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
13163 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13164 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
13166 if (mode_line_update_needed (w))
13167 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13169 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
13171 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
13173 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines
13174 || buffer_shared_and_changed ()
13175 || cursor_type_changed);
13177 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13178 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13179 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13180 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
13182 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13183 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13184 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13185 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13186 the echo area should be cleared. */
13187 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13188 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13189 || (message_cleared_p
13190 && minibuf_level == 0
13191 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13192 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13193 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13195 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13197 if (message_cleared_p)
13198 update_miniwindow_p = 1;
13200 must_finish = 1;
13202 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13203 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13204 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13205 the echo area. */
13206 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13207 message_cleared_p = 0;
13209 if (fonts_changed_p)
13210 goto retry;
13211 else if (window_height_changed_p)
13213 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13214 ++update_mode_lines;
13215 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13217 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13218 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13219 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13220 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13223 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13224 && (current_buffer->clip_changed || window_outdated (w))
13225 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13227 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13228 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13229 must_finish = 1;
13230 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
13231 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function
13232 needs to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
13233 consider_all_frames. */
13234 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13235 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13236 ++update_mode_lines;
13238 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13239 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13240 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13241 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13245 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
13246 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
13247 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
13248 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13249 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
13250 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
13251 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
13252 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
13253 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
13254 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13256 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13257 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13258 set in display_line and record information about the line
13259 containing the cursor. */
13260 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13261 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13262 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13263 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13264 && !w->update_mode_line
13265 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13266 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13267 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13268 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13269 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13270 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13271 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
13272 && !w->force_start
13273 && !w->optional_new_start
13274 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13275 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13276 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13277 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13278 must be unchanged. */
13279 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13280 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13282 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13283 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13284 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13285 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13286 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13287 goto cancel;
13288 else if (window_outdated (w) || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13290 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13291 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13292 line 1340).
13294 For instance, in the following case:
13296 -------- Insert --------
13297 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13298 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13299 ^^ ^^
13300 -------- --------
13302 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13303 optimization. */
13305 struct it it;
13306 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13308 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13309 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13310 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13312 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13313 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13314 goto cancel;
13316 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13317 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13318 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13319 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13320 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13321 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13322 display_line (&it);
13324 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13325 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13326 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13327 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13328 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13329 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13330 /* Line ends as before. */
13331 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13332 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13333 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13334 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13336 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13337 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13338 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13340 struct glyph_row *row
13341 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13342 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13344 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13345 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13346 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13347 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13348 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13349 delta = (Z
13350 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13351 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13352 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13353 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13354 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13356 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13357 this_line_vpos + 1,
13358 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13359 delta, delta_bytes);
13362 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13363 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13364 adjusted. */
13365 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
13367 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
13368 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos));
13370 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
13371 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13372 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos - 1));
13373 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
13375 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13376 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13378 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13379 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13380 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13381 #endif
13382 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13383 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13384 #endif
13385 goto update;
13387 else
13388 goto cancel;
13390 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13391 PT == w->last_point
13392 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13393 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13394 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13395 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13397 if (!must_finish)
13399 do_pending_window_change (1);
13400 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13401 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13402 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13403 goto retry;
13405 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13406 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13407 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13408 goto end_of_redisplay;
13410 goto update;
13412 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13413 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13414 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13415 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13416 && (EQ (selected_window,
13417 BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13418 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13419 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13420 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13421 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13423 struct it it;
13424 struct glyph_row *row;
13426 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13427 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13428 next visible position. */
13429 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13430 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13431 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13432 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13433 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13435 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13436 moves over before-strings. */
13437 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13439 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13440 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13441 row->enabled_p))
13443 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13444 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13445 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13446 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13447 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13448 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13449 #endif
13450 goto update;
13452 else
13453 goto cancel;
13456 cancel:
13457 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13458 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13461 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13462 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared_and_changed ();
13463 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13464 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13465 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13466 #endif
13468 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13469 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13470 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13472 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13474 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13475 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13477 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13478 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13479 buffer_shared = 0;
13481 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13485 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13486 frames. */
13487 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13488 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13489 continue;
13491 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13493 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13494 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13495 variables. */
13496 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13498 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13499 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13500 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13501 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13503 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13504 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13506 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13507 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13508 continue;
13510 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13511 nuked should now go away. */
13512 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13513 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13515 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13516 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13517 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13518 if (fonts_changed_p)
13519 goto retry;
13521 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13523 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13524 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13526 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13527 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13528 goto retry;
13531 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13532 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13533 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13534 error. */
13535 if (interrupt_input)
13536 unrequest_sigio ();
13537 STOP_POLLING;
13539 /* Update the display. */
13540 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13541 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13542 f->updated_p = 1;
13547 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13548 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13549 sure this stays contained. */
13550 ensure_selected_frame (old_frame);
13551 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window, selected_window));
13553 if (!pending)
13555 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13556 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13557 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13558 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13560 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13561 if (f->updated_p)
13563 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13564 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13565 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13570 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13572 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13573 struct frame *mini_frame;
13575 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13576 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13577 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13578 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13579 list_of_error,
13580 redisplay_window_error);
13581 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13582 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13583 list_of_error,
13584 redisplay_window_error);
13586 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13588 update:
13589 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13590 if (fonts_changed_p)
13591 goto retry;
13593 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13594 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13595 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13596 if (interrupt_input)
13597 unrequest_sigio ();
13598 STOP_POLLING;
13600 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13602 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13603 goto retry;
13605 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13606 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13609 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13610 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13611 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13612 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13613 it here. */
13614 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13615 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13617 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13619 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13620 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13621 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13622 goto retry;
13626 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13627 thorough update the next time. */
13628 if (pending)
13630 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13631 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13632 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13633 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13635 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13636 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13638 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13639 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13640 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13641 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13642 update_mode_lines = 1;
13644 else
13646 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13648 /* This has already been done above if
13649 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13650 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13652 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13653 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13655 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13656 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13659 update_mode_lines = 0;
13660 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13661 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13664 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13665 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13666 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13667 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13668 if (interrupt_input)
13669 request_sigio ();
13670 RESUME_POLLING;
13672 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13673 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13674 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13675 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13676 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13677 frames here explicitly. */
13678 if (!pending)
13680 int new_count = 0;
13682 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13684 int this_is_visible = 0;
13686 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13687 this_is_visible = 1;
13688 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13689 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13690 this_is_visible = 1;
13692 if (this_is_visible)
13693 new_count++;
13696 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13697 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13700 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13701 do_pending_window_change (1);
13703 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13704 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13705 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13706 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13707 goto retry;
13709 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13711 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13712 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13713 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13715 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13717 clear_face_cache (0);
13718 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13721 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13722 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13724 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13725 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13727 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13729 end_of_redisplay:
13730 backtrace_list = backtrace.next;
13731 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13732 RESUME_POLLING;
13736 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13737 another message has been requested in its place.
13739 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13740 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13741 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13742 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13744 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13745 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13747 void
13748 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13750 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13752 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13754 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13755 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13756 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13757 redisplay_internal ();
13758 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13760 else
13761 redisplay_internal ();
13763 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13764 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13765 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13769 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in redisplay_internal.
13770 Clear redisplaying_p. Also select the previously selected frame. */
13772 static Lisp_Object
13773 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object old_frame)
13775 redisplaying_p = 0;
13776 ensure_selected_frame (old_frame);
13777 return Qnil;
13781 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13782 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13783 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13784 redisplay_internal is called. */
13786 static void
13787 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13789 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13791 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13793 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13794 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13795 w->last_had_star
13796 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13798 if (accurate_p)
13800 b->clip_changed = 0;
13801 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13803 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13804 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13805 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13806 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13808 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13809 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13810 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13812 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13813 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13815 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13816 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13817 else
13818 w->last_point = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
13822 if (accurate_p)
13824 wset_window_end_valid (w, w->buffer);
13825 w->update_mode_line = 0;
13830 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13831 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13832 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13833 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13835 void
13836 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13838 struct window *w;
13840 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13842 w = XWINDOW (window);
13843 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13845 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13846 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13847 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13848 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13851 if (accurate_p)
13853 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13855 else
13857 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13858 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13859 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13860 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13865 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13866 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13867 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13868 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13870 Lisp_Object
13871 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13873 Lisp_Object val;
13875 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13877 val = dp->ascii;
13878 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13879 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13881 else
13883 Lisp_Object table;
13885 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13886 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13888 if (NILP (val))
13889 val = dp->defalt;
13890 return val;
13895 /***********************************************************************
13896 Window Redisplay
13897 ***********************************************************************/
13899 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13901 static void
13902 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13904 while (!NILP (window))
13906 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13908 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13909 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13910 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13911 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13912 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13914 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13915 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13916 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13917 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13918 list_of_error,
13919 redisplay_window_error);
13922 window = w->next;
13926 static Lisp_Object
13927 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13929 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13930 return Qnil;
13933 static Lisp_Object
13934 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13936 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13937 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13938 return Qnil;
13941 static Lisp_Object
13942 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13944 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13945 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13946 return Qnil;
13950 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13951 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13952 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13953 positions.
13955 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13957 static int
13958 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13959 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13960 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
13961 int dy, int dvpos)
13963 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13964 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13965 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13966 /* The last known character position in row. */
13967 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13968 int x = row->x;
13969 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
13970 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13971 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13972 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13973 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13974 touch. */
13975 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13976 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13977 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13978 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13979 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13980 display string. */
13981 int string_seen = 0;
13982 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13983 glyph row. */
13984 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
13985 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
13986 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13987 `cursor' property. */
13988 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
13989 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13990 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13991 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13993 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
13994 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
13995 deal with such calamities. */
13996 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
13997 if (row->mode_line_p)
13998 return 0;
14000 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
14001 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
14002 terminal frames. */
14003 if (row->displays_text_p)
14005 if (!row->reversed_p)
14007 while (glyph < end
14008 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14009 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14011 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14012 ++glyph;
14014 while (end > glyph
14015 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
14016 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
14017 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
14018 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
14019 --end;
14020 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
14021 glyph_after = end;
14023 else
14025 struct glyph *g;
14027 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
14028 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
14029 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
14030 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
14032 while (glyph > end + 1
14033 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14034 && glyph->charpos < 0)
14036 --glyph;
14037 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14039 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
14040 --glyph;
14041 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
14042 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
14043 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
14044 x += g->pixel_width;
14045 while (end < glyph
14046 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14047 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14048 ++end;
14049 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14050 glyph_after = end;
14053 else if (row->reversed_p)
14055 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14056 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14057 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14058 cursor = end - 1;
14059 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14060 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14061 adjacent windows. */
14062 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14063 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14064 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14065 cursor--;
14066 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14069 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14070 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14071 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14072 point, the other after it. */
14073 if (!row->reversed_p)
14074 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14075 glyph < end
14076 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14077 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14079 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14081 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14083 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14084 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14085 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14086 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14087 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14089 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14090 display the cursor. */
14091 if (dpos == 0)
14093 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14094 break;
14096 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14097 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14098 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14100 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14101 glyph_before = glyph;
14103 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14105 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14106 glyph_after = glyph;
14109 else if (dpos == 0)
14110 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14112 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14114 Lisp_Object chprop;
14115 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14117 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14118 glyph->object);
14119 if (!NILP (chprop))
14121 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14122 look up the buffer position of that property and
14123 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14124 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14125 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14126 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14127 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14128 text is completely covered by display properties,
14129 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14130 ever seen in the row. */
14131 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14132 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14133 pos_after, 0);
14135 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14136 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14138 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14140 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14141 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14142 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14143 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14144 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14145 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14146 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14147 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14148 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14149 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14150 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14151 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14152 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14154 cursor = glyph;
14155 break;
14159 string_seen = 1;
14161 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14162 ++glyph;
14164 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14165 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14167 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14169 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14171 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14172 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14173 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14174 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14175 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14177 if (dpos == 0)
14179 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14180 break;
14182 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14184 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14185 glyph_before = glyph;
14187 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14189 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14190 glyph_after = glyph;
14193 else if (dpos == 0)
14194 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14196 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14198 Lisp_Object chprop;
14199 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14201 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14202 glyph->object);
14203 if (!NILP (chprop))
14205 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14206 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14207 pos_after, 0);
14209 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14210 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14212 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14214 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14215 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14216 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14217 this glyph. */
14218 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14220 cursor = glyph;
14221 break;
14224 string_seen = 1;
14226 --glyph;
14227 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14229 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14230 break;
14232 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14235 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14236 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14237 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14238 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14239 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14240 && !(bpos_max < pt_old && pt_old <= bpos_covered))
14242 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14243 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14244 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14245 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14246 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14247 int empty_line_p =
14248 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14249 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0;
14251 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14253 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14255 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14256 if (!row->reversed_p)
14258 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14259 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14260 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14261 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14262 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14263 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14264 that one. */
14265 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14266 glyph++;
14268 else /* row is reversed */
14270 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14271 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14272 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14273 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14274 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14275 glyph--;
14278 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14280 cursor = glyph_after;
14281 x = -1;
14283 else if (string_seen)
14285 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14287 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14288 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14289 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14290 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14291 buffer. */
14292 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14293 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14295 x = -1;
14297 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14298 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14299 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14300 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14301 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14302 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14304 glyph_after = end;
14305 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14308 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14309 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14310 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14311 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14312 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14313 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14314 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14315 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14316 if (!row->reversed_p)
14318 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14319 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14321 else
14323 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14324 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14326 for (glyph = start + incr;
14327 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14330 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14331 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14332 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14333 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14335 Lisp_Object str;
14336 ptrdiff_t tem;
14337 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14338 need to search for it one position farther. */
14339 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14340 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14342 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14343 str = glyph->object;
14344 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14345 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14346 || pos <= tem)
14348 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14349 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14350 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14351 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14352 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14353 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14354 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14355 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14356 unidirectional version, we will display the
14357 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14358 if (tem == 0
14359 || tem == pt_old
14360 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14362 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14363 been reordered. Find the one with the
14364 smallest string position. Or there could
14365 be a character in the string with the
14366 `cursor' property, which means display
14367 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14368 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14370 if (tem)
14372 cursor = glyph;
14373 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14375 for ( ;
14376 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14377 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14378 glyph += incr)
14380 Lisp_Object cprop;
14381 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14383 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14384 Qcursor,
14385 glyph->object);
14386 if (!NILP (cprop))
14388 cursor = glyph;
14389 break;
14391 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14393 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14394 cursor = glyph;
14398 if (tem == pt_old
14399 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14400 goto compute_x;
14402 if (tem)
14403 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14405 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14406 glyphs that came from it. */
14407 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14408 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14409 glyph += incr;
14411 else
14412 glyph += incr;
14415 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14416 the cursor is not on this line. */
14417 if (cursor == NULL
14418 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14419 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14420 && STRINGP (end->object)
14421 && row->continued_p)
14422 return 0;
14424 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14425 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14426 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14427 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14428 code below to figure this out. */
14429 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14431 cursor = glyph_before;
14432 x = -1;
14434 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14435 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14436 || (!empty_line_p
14437 && (row->reversed_p
14438 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14439 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14441 cursor = glyph_after;
14442 x = -1;
14446 compute_x:
14447 if (cursor != NULL)
14448 glyph = cursor;
14449 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14450 && pos_before == pos_after
14451 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14452 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14453 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14455 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14456 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14457 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14458 use case. */
14459 glyph =
14460 row->reversed_p
14461 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14462 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14464 if (x < 0)
14466 struct glyph *g;
14468 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14469 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14471 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14472 emacs_abort ();
14473 x += g->pixel_width;
14477 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14478 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14479 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14480 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14481 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14482 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14483 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14484 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14485 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14486 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14487 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14488 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14489 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14490 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14491 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14492 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14493 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14495 struct glyph *g1 =
14496 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14498 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14499 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14500 return 0;
14501 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14502 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14503 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14504 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14505 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14506 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14507 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14508 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14509 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14510 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14511 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14512 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14513 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14514 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14515 Qcursor, g1->object))
14516 /* previous candidate is from the same display
14517 string as this one, and the display string
14518 came from a text property */
14519 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14520 && string_from_text_prop)
14521 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14522 position is not an exact match */
14523 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14524 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14525 return 0;
14526 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14527 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14528 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14529 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14530 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14531 || (!row->continued_p
14532 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14533 && glyph->charpos == 0
14534 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14535 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14536 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14537 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14538 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14539 positions. */
14540 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14541 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14542 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14543 return 0;
14545 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14546 w->cursor.x = x;
14547 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14548 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14550 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14552 if (!row->continued_p
14553 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14554 && row->x == 0)
14556 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14558 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14559 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14560 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14561 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14563 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14564 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14565 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14566 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14568 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14569 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14570 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14571 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14573 else
14574 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14577 return 1;
14581 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14582 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14584 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14586 static struct text_pos
14587 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14589 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14590 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14592 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14593 emacs_abort ();
14595 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14597 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14598 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14599 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14600 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14601 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14604 return startp;
14608 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14609 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14610 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14611 or we cannot tell.)
14613 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14614 is higher than window.
14616 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14617 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14619 static int
14620 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14622 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14623 struct glyph_row *row;
14624 int window_height;
14626 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14627 return 1;
14629 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14630 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14631 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14632 return 1;
14634 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14635 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14637 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14638 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14639 return 1;
14641 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14642 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14643 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14644 if (row->height >= window_height)
14646 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14647 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14648 return 1;
14650 return 0;
14654 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14655 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14656 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14657 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14658 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14660 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14661 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14663 Value is
14665 1 if scrolling succeeded
14667 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14669 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14670 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14672 enum
14674 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14675 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14676 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14679 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14681 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14682 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14683 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14685 static int
14686 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14687 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14688 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14690 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14691 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14692 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14693 struct it it;
14694 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14695 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14696 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14697 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14698 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14699 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14701 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14702 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14703 #endif
14705 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14707 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14708 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14709 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14710 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14711 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14712 else
14713 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14715 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14716 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14717 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14718 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14719 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14721 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14722 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14724 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14725 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14726 point into view. */
14727 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14728 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14729 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14730 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14731 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14732 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14733 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14734 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14735 else
14736 scroll_max = 0;
14738 too_near_end:
14740 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14741 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14743 int scroll_margin_y;
14745 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14746 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14747 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14748 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14749 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14750 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14751 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14753 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14755 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14756 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14757 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14758 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14759 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14760 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14761 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14762 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14764 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14765 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14766 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14767 fully visible. */
14768 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14769 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14770 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14772 if (dy > scroll_max)
14773 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14775 if (dy > 0)
14776 scroll_down_p = 1;
14780 if (scroll_down_p)
14782 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14783 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14784 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14785 move it down by scroll_step. */
14786 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14787 amount_to_scroll
14788 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14789 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14790 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14791 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14792 else
14794 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14795 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14796 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14798 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14799 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14800 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14801 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14802 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14803 the window. This could happen if the value of
14804 scroll_up_aggressively is too large and there are
14805 non-zero margins, because scroll_up_aggressively
14806 means put point that fraction of window height
14807 _from_the_bottom_margin_. */
14808 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14809 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14810 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14814 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14815 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14817 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14818 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14819 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14820 else
14822 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14823 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14824 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14825 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14826 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14827 below window bottom have different height. */
14828 struct it it1;
14829 void *it1data = NULL;
14830 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14831 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14832 int start_y;
14834 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14835 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14836 do {
14837 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14838 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14839 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14840 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14843 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14844 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14845 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14846 startp = it.current.pos;
14848 else
14850 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14852 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14853 window. */
14854 if (this_scroll_margin)
14856 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14857 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14858 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14861 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14863 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14864 above what is displayed in the window. */
14865 int y0, y_to_move;
14867 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14868 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14869 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14870 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max or if we
14871 didn't reach the scroll margin position. */
14872 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14873 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14874 y0 = it.current_y;
14875 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14876 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14877 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14878 y_to_move, -1,
14879 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14880 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14881 if (dy > scroll_max
14882 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14883 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14885 /* Compute new window start. */
14886 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14888 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14889 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14890 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14891 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14892 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14893 else
14895 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14896 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14897 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14899 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14900 int aggressive_scroll = float_amount;
14901 if (aggressive_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14902 aggressive_scroll = 1;
14903 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14904 bottom of the window, if the value of
14905 scroll_down_aggressively happens to be too
14906 large. */
14907 if (aggressive_scroll + 2*this_scroll_margin > height)
14908 aggressive_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin;
14909 amount_to_scroll = dy + aggressive_scroll;
14913 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14914 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14916 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14917 startp = it.current.pos;
14921 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14922 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14924 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14925 doesn't appear. */
14926 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14927 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14928 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14930 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14931 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14933 else
14935 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14936 if (!just_this_one_p
14937 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14938 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14939 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
14941 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14942 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14943 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14944 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14945 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14946 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14947 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14949 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14950 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14951 goto too_near_end;
14953 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14956 return rc;
14960 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14961 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14962 was computed.
14964 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14965 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14966 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14968 static int
14969 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14971 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14972 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14974 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14976 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14977 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14978 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14979 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14980 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14982 struct it it;
14983 struct glyph_row *row;
14985 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14986 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14987 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14988 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14989 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14991 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14992 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14993 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14994 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14995 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14996 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14998 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14999 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
15000 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
15001 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
15003 int min_distance, distance;
15005 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
15006 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
15007 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
15008 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
15009 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
15010 minimum distance from the old window start. */
15011 pos = it.current.pos;
15012 min_distance = INFINITY;
15013 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
15014 distance < min_distance)
15016 min_distance = distance;
15017 pos = it.current.pos;
15018 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
15021 /* Set the window start there. */
15022 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
15023 window_start_changed_p = 1;
15027 return window_start_changed_p;
15031 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
15032 with window start STARTP. Value is
15034 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
15036 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
15038 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
15039 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
15040 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
15042 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
15043 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
15044 first. */
15046 enum
15048 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
15049 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
15050 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
15051 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
15054 static int
15055 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15057 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15058 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15059 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15061 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15062 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15063 return rc;
15064 #endif
15066 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15067 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15068 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15069 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15071 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15072 not moved off the frame. */
15073 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15074 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15075 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15076 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15077 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15078 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15079 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15080 cases. */
15081 && !update_mode_lines
15082 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15083 && !cursor_type_changed
15084 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
15085 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
15086 set the cursor. */
15087 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15088 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15089 && NILP (w->region_showing)
15090 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15091 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15092 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15093 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15094 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15095 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15096 handles the same cases. */
15097 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15098 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
15099 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
15100 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
15101 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
15102 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
15103 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
15104 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
15105 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15106 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15108 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15109 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15111 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15112 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15113 #endif
15115 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15116 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15117 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15119 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15120 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15122 else
15123 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15125 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15126 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15127 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15129 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15130 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15131 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
15132 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15133 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15134 else
15136 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
15137 if (row->mode_line_p)
15138 ++row;
15139 if (!row->enabled_p)
15140 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15143 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15145 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15146 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15148 if (PT > w->last_point)
15150 /* Point has moved forward. */
15151 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15152 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15154 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15155 ++row;
15158 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15159 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15160 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15161 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15162 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15163 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
15164 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
15165 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15166 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15167 ++row;
15169 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15170 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15171 the next line would be drawn, and that
15172 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15173 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15174 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15175 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15176 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15177 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15178 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15179 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15180 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15181 scroll_p = 1;
15183 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15185 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15186 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15187 while (!row->mode_line_p
15188 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15189 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15190 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15191 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15192 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15193 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15194 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15195 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15197 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15198 --row;
15201 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15202 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15203 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15204 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15205 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15206 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15207 || row->mode_line_p)
15209 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15210 if (row->mode_line_p)
15211 ++row;
15214 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15215 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15216 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15217 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15218 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15219 ++row;
15221 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15222 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15223 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15224 scroll_p = 1;
15226 else
15228 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15229 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15230 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15233 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15234 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15236 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15237 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15238 must_scroll = 1;
15240 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15241 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15243 struct glyph_row *row1;
15245 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15246 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15247 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15248 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15249 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15250 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15251 in such rows. */
15252 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15253 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15254 bidi-reordered rows. */
15255 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15256 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15257 --row)
15259 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15260 without finding the first row of a continued
15261 line, give up. */
15262 if (row <= row1)
15264 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15265 break;
15267 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15270 if (must_scroll)
15272 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15273 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15274 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15275 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15276 && !row->mode_line_p
15277 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15279 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15280 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15281 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15282 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15283 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15285 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15286 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15287 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15288 about it. */
15289 *scroll_step = 1;
15290 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15292 else
15294 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15295 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15296 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15297 else
15298 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15301 else if (scroll_p)
15302 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15303 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15304 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15306 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15307 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15308 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15309 find the best candidate. */
15310 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15311 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15312 bidi-reordered rows. */
15313 int rv = 0;
15317 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15319 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15320 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15321 && cursor_row_p (row))
15322 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15323 0, 0, 0, 0);
15324 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15325 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15326 is set, we are done. */
15327 at_zv_p =
15328 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15329 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15330 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15331 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15332 w->cursor.vpos))
15334 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15335 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15336 struct glyph *g =
15337 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15338 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15340 exact_match_p =
15341 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15342 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15343 && (g->charpos == PT
15344 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15346 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15348 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15349 break;
15351 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15352 break;
15353 ++row;
15355 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15356 || row->continued_p)
15357 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15358 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15359 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15360 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15361 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15362 to the caller that this method failed. */
15363 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15364 && !(rv
15365 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15366 && !row->continued_p))
15367 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15368 else if (rv)
15369 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15371 else
15375 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15377 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15378 break;
15380 ++row;
15382 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15383 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15384 && cursor_row_p (row));
15389 return rc;
15392 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15393 static
15394 #endif
15395 void
15396 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15398 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15400 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15401 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15402 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15403 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15404 visible region.
15406 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15407 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15408 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15409 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15411 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15412 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15413 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15414 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15415 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15416 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15418 if (end < start)
15419 end = start;
15420 if (whole < (end - start))
15421 whole = end - start;
15423 else
15424 start = end = whole = 0;
15426 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15427 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15428 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15429 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15433 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15434 selected_window is redisplayed.
15436 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
15437 fonts_changed_p. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15438 retry. */
15440 static void
15441 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15443 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15444 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15445 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15446 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15447 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15448 int update_mode_line;
15449 int tem;
15450 struct it it;
15451 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15452 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15453 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15454 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15455 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15456 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15457 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15458 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15459 int rc;
15460 int centering_position = -1;
15461 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15462 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15464 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15465 opoint = lpoint;
15467 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15468 eassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15469 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15470 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15471 #endif
15473 restart:
15474 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15476 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15477 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15478 || update_mode_lines
15479 || buffer->clip_changed
15480 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15482 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15484 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15485 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15487 if (update_mode_line)
15488 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15489 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15490 goto finish_menu_bars;
15491 else
15492 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15493 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15495 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15496 || minibuf_level == 0)
15497 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15498 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15499 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15500 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15501 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15503 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15504 it. */
15505 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15506 struct glyph_row *row;
15507 int y;
15509 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15510 y < yb;
15511 y += row->height, ++row)
15512 blank_row (w, row, y);
15513 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15516 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15519 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15520 value. */
15521 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15522 variables. */
15523 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15525 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15526 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15527 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15528 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15529 && !window_outdated (w));
15531 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15532 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15533 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15534 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15535 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15537 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15538 goto restart;
15541 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15542 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15544 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15546 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15548 buffer_unchanged_p
15549 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15550 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15551 && !window_outdated (w));
15553 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15554 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15555 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15557 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15558 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15559 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15560 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15562 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15565 /* Some sanity checks. */
15566 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15567 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15568 emacs_abort ();
15569 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15570 emacs_abort ();
15572 if (mode_line_update_needed (w))
15573 update_mode_line = 1;
15575 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15576 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15577 if (!just_this_one_p)
15579 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15580 current_base = current_buffer;
15581 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15582 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15583 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15584 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15585 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15586 if (current_base == window_base)
15587 buffer_shared++;
15590 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15591 window, set up appropriate value. */
15592 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15594 ptrdiff_t new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15595 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15596 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15598 new_pt = BEGV;
15599 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15600 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15602 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15604 new_pt = ZV;
15605 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15606 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15609 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15610 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15613 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15614 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15615 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15616 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15617 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15618 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15620 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15622 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15623 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15625 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15626 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15627 BEG, Z);
15628 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15632 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15633 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15634 goto recenter;
15636 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15638 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15639 check whether it can be used. */
15640 if (w->optional_new_start
15641 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15642 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15644 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15645 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15646 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15647 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15648 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15649 w->force_start = 1;
15650 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15651 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15652 w->force_start = 1;
15655 force_start:
15657 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15658 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15659 if (w->force_start || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15661 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15662 int new_vpos = -1;
15664 w->force_start = 0;
15665 w->vscroll = 0;
15666 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15668 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15669 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15670 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15672 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15673 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15674 because we have scrolled. */
15675 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15676 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15677 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15678 and having them get more errors. */
15679 if (!update_mode_line
15680 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15682 update_mode_line = 1;
15683 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15684 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15687 w->last_modified = 0;
15688 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15689 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15690 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15691 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15692 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15694 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15695 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15696 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15697 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15698 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15699 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15701 w->force_start = 1;
15702 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15703 goto need_larger_matrices;
15706 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15708 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15709 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15710 can use it here. */
15711 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15714 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15716 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15717 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15718 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15721 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15722 now actually do it. */
15723 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15725 struct glyph_row *row;
15727 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15728 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15729 ++row;
15731 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15732 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15734 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15735 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15736 else if (current_buffer == old)
15737 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15739 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15741 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15742 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15743 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15744 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15746 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15747 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15748 goto need_larger_matrices;
15752 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15753 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15754 #endif
15755 goto done;
15758 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15759 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15760 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15761 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15762 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15763 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15765 switch (rc)
15767 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15768 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15769 goto done;
15771 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15772 goto try_to_scroll;
15774 default:
15775 emacs_abort ();
15778 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15779 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15780 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15781 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15782 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15784 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15785 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15786 #endif
15787 goto recenter;
15790 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15791 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15792 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15793 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15795 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15796 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15797 #endif
15799 if (fonts_changed_p)
15800 goto need_larger_matrices;
15801 if (tem > 0)
15802 goto done;
15804 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15805 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15807 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15808 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15809 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15810 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15811 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15812 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15813 || !window_outdated (w)))
15815 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15817 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15818 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15819 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15821 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15822 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15823 new window start, since that would change the position under
15824 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15825 than a simple mouse-click. */
15826 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15827 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15828 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15829 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15830 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15831 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15832 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15833 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15834 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15835 bug#197). */
15836 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15837 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15838 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15839 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15840 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15841 doing so will move point from its correct position
15842 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15843 See bug#9324. */
15844 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15846 w->force_start = 1;
15847 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15848 goto force_start;
15851 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15852 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15853 #endif
15855 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15856 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15857 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15858 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15859 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15860 buffer. */
15861 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15862 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15863 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15864 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15866 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15867 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15868 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15869 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15870 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15871 goto try_to_scroll;
15874 if (fonts_changed_p)
15875 goto need_larger_matrices;
15877 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15879 if (!just_this_one_p
15880 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15881 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15882 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15883 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15885 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15887 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15888 last_line_misfit = 1;
15890 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15891 else
15892 goto done;
15894 else
15895 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15898 try_to_scroll:
15900 w->last_modified = 0;
15901 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15903 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15904 if (!update_mode_line)
15906 update_mode_line = 1;
15907 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15910 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15911 if ((scroll_conservatively
15912 || emacs_scroll_step
15913 || temp_scroll_step
15914 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15915 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15916 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15917 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15919 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15920 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15921 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15922 scroll_conservatively,
15923 emacs_scroll_step,
15924 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15925 switch (ss)
15927 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15928 goto done;
15930 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15931 goto need_larger_matrices;
15933 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15934 break;
15936 default:
15937 emacs_abort ();
15941 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15942 according to user preferences. */
15944 recenter:
15946 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15947 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15948 #endif
15950 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15952 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15953 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15954 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15956 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15957 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15958 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15959 if (centering_position < 0)
15961 int margin =
15962 scroll_margin > 0
15963 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15964 : 0;
15965 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15966 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15967 int scrolling_up;
15969 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15970 its character position. */
15971 if (margin
15972 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15973 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15974 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15975 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15976 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
15977 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15978 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15980 struct it it1;
15981 void *it1data = NULL;
15983 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15984 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15985 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
15986 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15987 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15989 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
15990 aggressive =
15991 scrolling_up
15992 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
15993 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15995 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15996 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
15998 int pt_offset = 0;
16000 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
16001 scroll-*-aggressively. */
16002 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
16004 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
16006 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
16007 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
16008 pt_offset = 1;
16009 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
16010 margin -= 1;
16012 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
16013 point so that point will be displayed where the user
16014 wants it. */
16015 if (scrolling_up)
16017 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
16018 if (pt_offset)
16019 centering_position -= pt_offset;
16020 centering_position -=
16021 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
16022 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16023 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
16024 the window. */
16025 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
16026 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16028 else
16029 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
16031 else
16032 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
16033 from point. */
16034 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
16036 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
16038 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
16040 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
16041 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
16042 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
16043 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16044 containing PT in this case. */
16045 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16047 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16048 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16049 it.current_y = 0;
16052 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16054 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16055 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16056 get errors. */
16057 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16059 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16060 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16062 /* Redisplay the window. */
16063 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16064 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16065 || cursor_type_changed
16066 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16067 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16068 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16069 || !just_this_one_p
16070 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16071 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16072 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16073 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16075 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16076 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16077 matrices. */
16078 if (fonts_changed_p)
16079 goto need_larger_matrices;
16081 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16082 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16083 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16084 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16085 line.) */
16086 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16088 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
16089 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
16091 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16092 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16093 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16095 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16097 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16098 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16099 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16101 else
16103 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16107 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16108 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16109 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16110 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16111 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16113 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16114 if (row->mode_line_p)
16115 ++row;
16116 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16119 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16121 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16122 if (w->vscroll)
16124 w->vscroll = 0;
16125 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16126 goto recenter;
16129 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16130 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16131 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16132 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16133 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16135 int margin =
16136 scroll_margin > 0
16137 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
16138 : 0;
16139 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 2;
16141 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16142 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16143 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16144 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16145 goto done;
16148 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16149 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16150 visible, if it can be done. */
16151 if (centering_position == 0)
16152 goto done;
16154 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16155 centering_position = 0;
16156 goto recenter;
16159 done:
16161 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16162 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16163 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16165 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16166 if ((update_mode_line
16167 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16168 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16169 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16170 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16171 || (!just_this_one_p
16172 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16173 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16174 /* Line number to display. */
16175 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
16176 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16177 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
16178 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
16179 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16180 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16181 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16183 display_mode_lines (w);
16185 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16186 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16187 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16188 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16190 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16191 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16192 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16195 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16196 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16197 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16198 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16200 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16201 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16202 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16205 if (fonts_changed_p)
16206 goto need_larger_matrices;
16209 if (!line_number_displayed
16210 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
16212 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
16213 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
16216 finish_menu_bars:
16218 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16219 if (update_mode_line
16220 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16222 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16224 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16226 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16227 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16228 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16229 #else
16230 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16231 #endif
16233 else
16234 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16236 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16237 display_menu_bar (w);
16239 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16240 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16242 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16243 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16244 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16245 #else
16246 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16247 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
16248 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16249 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16250 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16251 #endif
16253 #endif
16256 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16257 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16258 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16259 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16260 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16262 update_begin (f);
16263 block_input ();
16264 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16265 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16266 unblock_input ();
16267 update_end (f);
16269 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16271 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p set,
16272 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16273 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16274 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16275 need_larger_matrices:
16277 finish_scroll_bars:
16279 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16281 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16282 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16284 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16285 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16286 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16287 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16290 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16291 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16292 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16293 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16294 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16295 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16296 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16297 else
16298 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16300 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16301 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16302 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16303 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16304 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16306 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16310 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16311 buffer position POS.
16313 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16314 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16315 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16316 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16317 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16318 set in FLAGS.) */
16321 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16323 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16324 struct it it;
16325 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16326 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16328 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16329 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16331 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16332 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16333 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16335 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16336 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16338 /* Display all lines of W. */
16339 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16341 if (display_line (&it))
16342 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16343 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16344 return 0;
16347 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16348 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16349 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16351 int this_scroll_margin;
16353 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16355 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
16356 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16358 else
16359 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16361 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16362 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16363 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16364 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16365 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16366 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16367 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16368 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16369 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16371 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16372 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16373 return -1;
16377 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16378 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
16379 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16380 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16382 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16383 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16384 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16385 if (last_text_row)
16387 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16388 w->window_end_bytepos
16389 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16390 wset_window_end_pos
16391 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16392 wset_window_end_vpos
16393 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix)));
16394 eassert
16395 (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16396 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))->displays_text_p);
16398 else
16400 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16401 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16402 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16405 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16406 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16407 return 1;
16412 /************************************************************************
16413 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16414 ************************************************************************/
16416 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16417 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16418 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16419 W->start is the new window start. */
16421 static int
16422 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16424 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16425 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16426 struct it it;
16427 struct run run;
16428 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16429 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16430 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16431 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16432 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16433 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16435 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16436 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16437 return 0;
16438 #endif
16440 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16441 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16442 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16443 or such. */
16444 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16445 || cursor_type_changed)
16446 return 0;
16448 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16449 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16450 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16451 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16452 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16453 return 0;
16455 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16456 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16457 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16458 return 0;
16460 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16461 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16462 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16463 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16464 return 0;
16466 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16467 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16468 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16469 start = start_row->minpos;
16470 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16472 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16473 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16475 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16477 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16478 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16479 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16480 not a frequent case. */
16481 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16482 return 0;
16484 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16486 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16487 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16488 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16489 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16490 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16491 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16492 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16494 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16495 && !fonts_changed_p)
16497 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16498 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16499 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16500 work to start copying with the following row. */
16501 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16503 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16504 start_row++;
16505 start = start_row->minpos;
16506 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16507 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16508 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16509 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16511 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16512 return 0;
16515 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16517 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16518 rows. */
16519 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16520 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16521 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16522 that same display vector (thus their character
16523 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16524 that is the case. */
16525 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16526 break;
16528 if (display_line (&it))
16529 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16533 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16534 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16535 have at least one reusable row. */
16536 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16538 struct glyph_row *row;
16540 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16541 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16543 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16544 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16546 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16548 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16549 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16550 if (row)
16551 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16552 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16553 else
16555 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16556 return 0;
16560 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16561 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16562 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16563 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16564 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16565 in. */
16566 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16567 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16568 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16570 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16572 update_begin (f);
16573 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16574 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16575 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16576 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16577 update_end (f);
16580 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16581 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16582 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16583 start_vpos,
16584 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16585 nrows_scrolled);
16587 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16588 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16589 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16591 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16592 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16593 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16594 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16595 row < bottom_row;
16596 ++row)
16598 row->y = it.current_y;
16599 row->visible_height = row->height;
16601 if (row->y < min_y)
16602 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16603 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16604 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16605 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16606 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16608 it.current_y += row->height;
16610 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16611 last_reused_text_row = row;
16612 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16613 break;
16616 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16617 below the window. */
16618 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16619 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16622 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16623 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16624 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16625 containing text. */
16626 if (last_reused_text_row)
16628 w->window_end_bytepos
16629 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16630 wset_window_end_pos
16631 (w, make_number (Z
16632 - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row)));
16633 wset_window_end_vpos
16634 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16635 w->current_matrix)));
16637 else if (last_text_row)
16639 w->window_end_bytepos
16640 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16641 wset_window_end_pos
16642 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16643 wset_window_end_vpos
16644 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16645 w->desired_matrix)));
16647 else
16649 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16650 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16651 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16652 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16654 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16656 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16657 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16659 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16660 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16661 #endif
16662 return 1;
16664 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16666 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16667 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16668 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16669 int dy;
16670 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16672 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16673 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16674 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16675 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16676 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16677 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16678 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16679 ++first_reusable_row;
16681 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16682 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16683 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16684 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16685 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16686 return 0;
16688 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16689 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16690 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16691 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16692 pt_row = NULL;
16693 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16694 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16695 ++first_row_to_display)
16697 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16698 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16699 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16700 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16701 && pt_row == NULL)))
16702 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16705 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16706 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16707 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16709 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16710 - start_vpos);
16711 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16712 - nrows_scrolled);
16713 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16714 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16716 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16717 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16718 that displays text. */
16719 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16720 if (pt_row == NULL)
16721 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16722 last_text_row = NULL;
16723 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16724 if (display_line (&it))
16725 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16727 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16728 position. */
16729 if (pt_row)
16731 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16732 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16735 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16736 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16737 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16738 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16739 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16741 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16742 return 0;
16745 /* Scroll the display. */
16746 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16747 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16748 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16749 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16751 if (run.height)
16753 update_begin (f);
16754 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16755 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16756 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16757 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16758 update_end (f);
16761 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16762 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16763 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16764 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16765 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16767 row->y -= dy;
16768 row->visible_height = row->height;
16769 if (row->y < min_y)
16770 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16771 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16772 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16773 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16774 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16777 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16778 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16779 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16780 start_vpos,
16781 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16782 -nrows_scrolled);
16784 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16785 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16786 row->enabled_p = 0;
16788 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16789 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16790 if (pt_row)
16792 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16793 row < bottom_row
16794 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16795 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16796 row++)
16798 w->cursor.vpos++;
16799 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16801 if (row < bottom_row)
16803 /* Can't simply scan the row for point with
16804 bidi-reordered glyph rows. Let set_cursor_from_row
16805 figure out where to put the cursor, and if it fails,
16806 give up. */
16807 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16809 if (!set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
16810 0, 0, 0, 0))
16812 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16813 return 0;
16816 else
16818 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16819 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16821 for (; glyph < end
16822 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16823 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16824 glyph++)
16826 w->cursor.hpos++;
16827 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16833 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16834 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16835 only its vpos can have changed. */
16836 if (last_text_row)
16838 w->window_end_bytepos
16839 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16840 wset_window_end_pos
16841 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16842 wset_window_end_vpos
16843 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16844 w->desired_matrix)));
16846 else
16848 wset_window_end_vpos
16849 (w, make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled));
16852 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16853 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16855 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16856 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16857 #endif
16858 return 1;
16861 return 0;
16866 /************************************************************************
16867 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16868 ************************************************************************/
16870 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16871 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16872 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
16873 static struct glyph_row *
16874 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16875 struct glyph_row *);
16878 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16879 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16880 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16881 a pointer to the row found. */
16883 static struct glyph_row *
16884 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16885 struct glyph_row *start)
16887 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16889 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16890 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16891 visible lines. */
16892 row_found = NULL;
16893 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16894 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16896 eassert (row->enabled_p);
16897 row_found = row;
16898 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16899 break;
16900 ++row;
16903 return row_found;
16907 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16908 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16909 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16911 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16912 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16913 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16914 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16915 when the current matrix was built. */
16917 static struct glyph_row *
16918 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16920 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16921 struct glyph_row *row;
16922 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16923 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16925 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16926 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16927 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16928 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16929 ++row)
16931 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16932 except in some case. */
16933 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16934 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16935 unchanged. */
16936 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16937 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16938 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16939 continued. */
16940 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16941 && (row->continued_p
16942 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
16943 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
16944 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
16945 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
16946 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
16947 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
16948 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
16949 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
16950 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
16951 row_found = row;
16953 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16954 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16955 break;
16958 return row_found;
16962 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16963 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16964 time W's current matrix was built.
16966 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16967 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16969 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16971 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16972 changes. */
16974 static struct glyph_row *
16975 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16976 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
16978 struct glyph_row *row;
16979 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16981 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16983 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16984 is not up to date. */
16985 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16987 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16988 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16989 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
16990 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
16991 return NULL;
16993 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
16994 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16996 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
16997 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16999 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
17000 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
17001 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
17002 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
17003 positions for characters not in changed text. */
17004 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
17005 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17006 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
17007 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17008 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
17009 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
17010 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
17012 *delta = Z - Z_old;
17013 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17015 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
17016 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
17017 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
17018 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
17019 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
17020 position. */
17021 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
17022 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
17024 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
17025 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
17026 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
17028 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
17029 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
17030 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
17031 break;
17033 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
17034 row_found = row;
17038 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
17040 return row_found;
17044 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
17045 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
17046 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
17047 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
17048 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17050 static void
17051 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17053 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17054 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17056 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17057 must have a frame matrix. */
17058 eassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
17059 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17060 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17062 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17063 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17064 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17065 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17066 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17067 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17068 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17069 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17071 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17072 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17074 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17075 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17076 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17077 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17079 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17080 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17081 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17082 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
17084 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17089 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17090 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17091 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17092 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17094 struct glyph_row *
17095 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17096 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17098 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17099 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17100 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
17101 int last_y;
17103 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17104 if (row->mode_line_p)
17105 ++row;
17107 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17108 return NULL;
17110 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17112 while (1)
17114 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17115 if (end && row >= end)
17116 return NULL;
17117 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17118 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17119 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17120 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17121 return NULL;
17123 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17124 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17125 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17126 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17127 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17128 would rather display it in the next line, except
17129 when this line ends in ZV. */
17130 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17131 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
17132 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17134 struct glyph *g;
17136 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17137 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17138 return row;
17139 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
17140 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
17141 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
17142 CHARPOS the best. */
17143 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17144 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17145 g++)
17147 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17149 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17151 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17152 best_row = row;
17153 /* Exact match always wins. */
17154 if (mindif == 0)
17155 return best_row;
17160 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17161 return best_row;
17162 ++row;
17167 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17168 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17169 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
17171 Value is
17173 1 if display has been updated
17174 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17175 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17177 The following steps are performed:
17179 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17180 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17181 is found, give up.
17183 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17184 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17186 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17187 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17188 the window.
17190 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17192 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17193 display and current matrix as needed.
17195 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17196 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17197 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17198 in smaller font sizes.
17200 7. Update W's window end information. */
17202 static int
17203 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17205 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17206 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17207 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17208 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17209 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17210 struct glyph_row *row;
17211 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17212 int bottom_vpos;
17213 struct it it;
17214 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17215 int dvpos, dy;
17216 struct text_pos start_pos;
17217 struct run run;
17218 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17219 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17220 struct text_pos start;
17221 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17223 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17224 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17225 return 0;
17226 #endif
17228 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17229 #if 0
17230 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17231 do { \
17232 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17233 return 0; \
17234 } while (0)
17235 #else
17236 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17237 #endif
17239 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17241 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17242 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17243 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17244 GIVE_UP (1);
17246 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17247 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
17248 GIVE_UP (2);
17250 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17251 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17252 It would be nice to further
17253 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17254 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17255 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17256 GIVE_UP (3);
17258 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17259 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17260 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17261 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17262 GIVE_UP (4);
17264 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17265 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17266 GIVE_UP (5);
17268 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17269 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17270 GIVE_UP (6);
17272 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17273 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17274 GIVE_UP (7);
17276 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17277 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
17278 GIVE_UP (8);
17280 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
17281 will do more than just set the cursor. */
17282 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
17283 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
17284 GIVE_UP (9);
17286 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17287 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17288 GIVE_UP (11);
17290 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
17291 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
17292 GIVE_UP (10);
17294 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17295 changed. */
17296 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17297 GIVE_UP (12);
17299 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17300 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17301 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17302 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17303 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
17304 GIVE_UP (21);
17306 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17307 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17308 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17309 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17310 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17311 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17312 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17313 redisplay from scratch. */
17314 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17315 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17316 GIVE_UP (22);
17318 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17319 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17320 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17321 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17322 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17323 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17324 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17326 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17327 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17328 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17329 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17332 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17333 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17334 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17336 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17337 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17338 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17339 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17340 be adjusted, of course. */
17341 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17342 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17343 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17344 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17345 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17346 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17348 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17349 struct glyph_row *r0;
17351 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17352 from the buffer. */
17353 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17354 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17355 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17356 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17358 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17359 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17360 front of the window start. */
17361 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17362 GIVE_UP (13);
17364 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17365 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17366 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17367 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17368 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17369 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17370 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17371 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17372 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17374 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17375 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17377 struct glyph_row *r1
17378 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17379 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17380 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17381 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17382 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17385 /* Set the cursor. */
17386 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17387 if (row)
17388 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17389 else
17390 emacs_abort ();
17391 return 1;
17395 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17396 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17397 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17398 there that is visible in the window. */
17399 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17400 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17401 changes at ZV, actually. */
17402 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17403 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17405 struct glyph_row *r0;
17407 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17408 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17409 front of the window start. */
17410 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17411 GIVE_UP (14);
17413 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17414 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17415 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17416 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17417 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17418 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17419 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17420 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17422 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17423 could have been added/removed after it. */
17424 wset_window_end_pos
17425 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17426 w->window_end_bytepos
17427 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17429 /* Set the cursor. */
17430 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17431 if (row)
17432 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17433 else
17434 emacs_abort ();
17435 return 2;
17439 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17441 The condition used to read
17443 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17445 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17446 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17447 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17448 GIVE_UP (15);
17450 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17451 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17452 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17453 comparable. */
17454 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17455 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17456 GIVE_UP (16);
17458 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17459 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17460 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17461 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17462 GIVE_UP (20);
17464 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17465 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17466 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17467 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17468 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17469 first line of window. */
17470 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17471 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17473 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17474 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17475 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17476 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17477 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17478 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17479 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17480 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17482 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17483 GIVE_UP (17);
17485 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17486 GIVE_UP (18);
17487 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17489 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17490 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17491 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17492 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17493 current_matrix);
17494 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17495 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17497 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17499 else
17501 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17502 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17503 start_display (&it, w, start);
17504 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17505 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17508 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17509 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17510 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17511 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17512 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17513 changes. */
17514 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17515 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17516 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17517 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17519 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17520 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17521 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17522 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17523 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17524 stop_pos = 0;
17525 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17527 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17528 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17530 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17531 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17532 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17533 not displaying text. */
17534 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17535 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17536 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17537 < it.last_visible_y))
17538 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17540 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17541 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17542 >= it.last_visible_y))
17543 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17544 else
17546 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17547 + delta);
17548 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17549 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17550 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17553 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17554 GIVE_UP (19);
17557 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17559 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17560 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17561 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17562 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17563 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17565 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17566 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17567 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17568 : -1);
17569 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17571 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17574 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17575 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17576 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17577 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17578 last_text_row = NULL;
17579 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17580 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17581 && !fonts_changed_p
17582 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17583 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17585 if (display_line (&it))
17586 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17589 if (fonts_changed_p)
17590 return -1;
17593 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17594 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17595 scroll. */
17596 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17597 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17598 bottom of the window. */
17599 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17601 dvpos = (it.vpos
17602 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17603 current_matrix));
17604 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17605 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17606 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17607 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17609 else
17611 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17612 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17613 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17615 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17618 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17619 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17620 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17621 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17622 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17623 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17624 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17625 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17626 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17628 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17629 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17630 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17632 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17633 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17634 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17635 if (row)
17636 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17639 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17640 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17642 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17643 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17644 if (row)
17645 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17646 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17649 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17650 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17652 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17653 return -1;
17657 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17659 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17661 this_scroll_margin =
17662 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17663 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17664 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17666 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17667 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17668 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17669 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17670 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17671 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17672 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17674 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17675 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17676 return -1;
17680 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17681 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17682 found. */
17683 if (dy && run.height)
17685 update_begin (f);
17687 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17689 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17690 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17691 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17692 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17694 else
17696 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17697 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17698 int from_vpos
17699 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17700 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17701 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17702 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17703 + window_internal_height (w));
17705 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17706 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17707 #endif
17708 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17709 if (dvpos > 0)
17711 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17712 window down dvpos lines. */
17713 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17715 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17716 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17717 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17718 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17720 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17721 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17722 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17724 else if (dvpos < 0)
17726 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17727 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17728 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17730 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17731 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17732 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17733 line sequences. */
17734 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17736 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17737 end. */
17738 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17739 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17742 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17745 update_end (f);
17748 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17749 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17750 text. */
17751 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17752 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17753 if (dvpos < 0)
17755 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17756 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17757 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17758 bottom_vpos);
17760 else if (dvpos > 0)
17762 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17763 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17764 clear_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17765 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos);
17768 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17769 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17770 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17771 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17773 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17774 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17775 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17776 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17777 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17779 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17780 if (dy)
17781 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17782 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17783 bottom_vpos, dy);
17785 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17787 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17788 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17789 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17790 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17793 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17794 the window. */
17795 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17796 if (dy < 0)
17798 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17799 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17800 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17801 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17802 the matrix by dvpos. */
17803 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17804 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17806 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17807 eassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17809 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17810 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17811 line following it. */
17812 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17814 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17815 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17816 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17818 else
17820 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17821 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17822 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17823 ++last_row;
17826 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17827 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17828 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17829 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17831 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17832 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17833 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17834 && !fonts_changed_p)
17836 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17837 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17838 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17839 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17840 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17841 if (display_line (&it))
17842 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17846 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17847 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17848 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17850 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17851 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17852 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17853 scrolling. */
17854 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17855 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17856 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17857 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17859 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17860 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17861 wset_window_end_vpos
17862 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix)));
17863 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17864 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17866 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17868 wset_window_end_pos
17869 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end)));
17870 w->window_end_bytepos
17871 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17872 wset_window_end_vpos
17873 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end,
17874 desired_matrix)));
17875 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17876 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17878 else if (last_text_row)
17880 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17881 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17882 in the desired matrix. */
17883 wset_window_end_pos
17884 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
17885 w->window_end_bytepos
17886 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17887 wset_window_end_vpos
17888 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix)));
17889 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17891 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17892 && last_text_row == NULL
17893 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17895 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17896 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17897 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17898 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17899 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17900 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17902 for (row = NULL;
17903 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17904 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17906 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17908 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17909 row = desired_row;
17911 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17912 row = current_row;
17915 eassert (row != NULL);
17916 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (vpos + 1));
17917 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17918 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17919 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17920 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17922 else
17923 emacs_abort ();
17925 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17926 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17928 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17929 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
17930 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17931 return 3;
17933 #undef GIVE_UP
17938 /***********************************************************************
17939 More debugging support
17940 ***********************************************************************/
17942 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17944 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17945 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17946 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17949 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17951 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17952 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17953 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17955 void
17956 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17958 int i;
17959 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17960 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17964 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17965 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17967 void
17968 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17970 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17972 fprintf (stderr,
17973 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17974 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17975 'C',
17976 glyph->charpos,
17977 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17978 ? 'B'
17979 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17980 ? 'S'
17981 : '-')),
17982 glyph->pixel_width,
17983 glyph->u.ch,
17984 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17985 ? glyph->u.ch
17986 : '.'),
17987 glyph->face_id,
17988 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17989 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17991 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
17993 fprintf (stderr,
17994 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17995 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17996 'S',
17997 glyph->charpos,
17998 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17999 ? 'B'
18000 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18001 ? 'S'
18002 : '-')),
18003 glyph->pixel_width,
18005 '.',
18006 glyph->face_id,
18007 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18008 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18010 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
18012 fprintf (stderr,
18013 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18014 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18015 'I',
18016 glyph->charpos,
18017 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18018 ? 'B'
18019 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18020 ? 'S'
18021 : '-')),
18022 glyph->pixel_width,
18023 glyph->u.img_id,
18024 '.',
18025 glyph->face_id,
18026 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18027 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18029 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
18031 fprintf (stderr,
18032 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
18033 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
18034 '+',
18035 glyph->charpos,
18036 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18037 ? 'B'
18038 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
18039 ? 'S'
18040 : '-')),
18041 glyph->pixel_width,
18042 glyph->u.cmp.id);
18043 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
18044 fprintf (stderr,
18045 "[%d-%d]",
18046 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
18047 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18048 glyph->face_id,
18049 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18050 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18055 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18056 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18057 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18058 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18060 void
18061 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18063 if (glyphs != 1)
18065 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18066 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
18068 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18069 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18070 vpos,
18071 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18072 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18073 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18074 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18075 row->enabled_p,
18076 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18077 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18078 row->continued_p,
18079 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18080 row->displays_text_p,
18081 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18082 row->fill_line_p,
18083 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18084 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18085 row->mouse_face_p,
18086 row->x,
18087 row->y,
18088 row->pixel_width,
18089 row->height,
18090 row->visible_height,
18091 row->ascent,
18092 row->phys_ascent);
18093 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pD"d %5"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18094 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18095 row->continuation_lines_width);
18096 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
18097 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18098 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18099 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18100 row->end.dpvec_index);
18103 if (glyphs > 1)
18105 int area;
18107 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18109 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18110 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18112 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18113 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18114 ++glyph_end;
18116 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18117 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18119 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18120 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18123 else if (glyphs == 1)
18125 int area;
18127 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18129 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
18130 int i;
18132 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18134 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18135 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18136 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18137 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18138 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18139 else
18140 s[i] = '.';
18143 s[i] = '\0';
18144 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18150 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18151 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18152 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18153 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18154 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18155 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18156 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18158 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18159 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18161 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18162 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18163 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18164 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18165 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18166 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18167 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18168 return Qnil;
18172 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18173 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18174 (void)
18176 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18177 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18178 return Qnil;
18182 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18183 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18184 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18185 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18186 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18187 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18189 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18190 EMACS_INT vpos;
18192 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18193 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18194 vpos = XINT (row);
18195 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18196 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18197 vpos,
18198 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18199 return Qnil;
18203 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18204 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18205 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18206 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18207 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18208 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18210 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18211 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18212 EMACS_INT vpos;
18214 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18215 vpos = XINT (row);
18216 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18217 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18218 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18219 return Qnil;
18223 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18224 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18225 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18226 (Lisp_Object arg)
18228 if (NILP (arg))
18229 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18230 else
18232 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18233 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18236 return Qnil;
18240 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18241 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18242 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18243 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18245 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18246 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18247 return Qnil;
18250 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18254 /***********************************************************************
18255 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18256 ***********************************************************************/
18258 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18259 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18261 static struct glyph_row *
18262 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18264 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18265 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18266 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18267 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18268 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18269 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18270 const unsigned char *p;
18271 struct it it;
18272 int multibyte_p;
18273 int n_glyphs_before;
18275 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18276 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18277 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18278 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18280 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18281 p = arrow_string;
18282 while (p < arrow_end)
18284 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18286 /* Get the next character. */
18287 if (multibyte_p)
18288 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18289 else
18291 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18292 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18293 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18295 p += it.len;
18297 /* Get its face. */
18298 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18299 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18300 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18302 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18303 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18304 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18305 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18307 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18308 to remove some glyphs. */
18309 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18311 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18312 break;
18316 set_buffer_temp (old);
18317 return it.glyph_row;
18321 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18322 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18324 static void
18325 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18327 struct it truncate_it;
18328 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18330 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18331 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18332 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18333 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18334 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18336 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18337 truncate_it = *it;
18338 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18339 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18340 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18341 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18342 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18343 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18344 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18346 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18347 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18349 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18351 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18352 end = from + tused;
18353 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18354 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18355 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18357 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18358 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18359 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18360 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18361 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18362 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18363 the right. */
18364 int w = 0;
18365 struct glyph *g = to;
18366 short used;
18368 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18369 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18370 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18371 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18372 will begin. */
18373 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18374 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18376 w += g->pixel_width;
18377 ++g;
18379 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18381 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18382 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18384 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18385 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18386 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18387 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18388 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18390 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18392 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18396 while (from < end)
18397 *to++ = *from++;
18399 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18400 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18402 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18404 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18405 while (from < end)
18406 *to++ = *from++;
18410 if (to > toend)
18411 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18413 else
18415 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18417 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18418 that back to front. */
18419 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18420 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18421 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18422 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18423 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18425 int w = 0;
18426 struct glyph *g = to;
18428 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18430 w += g->pixel_width;
18431 --g;
18433 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18434 to = g + tused;
18435 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18436 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18437 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18439 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18441 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18445 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18446 *to-- = *from--;
18447 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18449 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18451 from =
18452 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18453 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18454 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18455 *to-- = *from--;
18458 if (from >= end)
18460 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18461 glyphs. */
18462 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18463 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18464 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18466 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18467 g[move_by] = *g;
18468 while (from >= end)
18469 *to-- = *from--;
18470 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18475 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18476 unsigned
18477 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18479 int area, k;
18480 unsigned hashval = 0;
18482 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18483 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18484 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18485 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18486 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18487 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18488 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18490 return hashval;
18493 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18495 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18496 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18497 structure. This is not the case if
18499 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18500 and max_height will be zero.
18502 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18503 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18504 pixmap extensions).
18506 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18507 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18508 must not be zero. */
18510 static void
18511 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18513 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18515 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18517 int i, min_y, max_y;
18519 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18520 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18521 computed yet. */
18522 if (row->height == 0)
18524 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18525 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18526 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18527 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18528 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18529 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18530 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18533 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18534 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18535 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18536 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18538 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18539 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18541 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18542 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18544 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18545 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18546 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18547 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18548 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18550 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18551 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18554 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18555 row->visible_height = row->height;
18557 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18558 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18560 if (row->y < min_y)
18561 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18562 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18563 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18565 else
18567 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18568 if (row->continued_p)
18569 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18570 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18571 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18572 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18573 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18574 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18577 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18578 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18580 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18581 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18585 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18586 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18587 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18589 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18590 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18591 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18592 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18594 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18595 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18597 static int
18598 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18600 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18602 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18604 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18605 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18607 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18608 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18609 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18610 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18611 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18612 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18613 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18614 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18615 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18616 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18617 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18618 struct face *face;
18620 saved_object = it->object;
18621 saved_pos = it->position;
18623 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18624 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18625 it->object = make_number (0);
18626 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18627 it->len = 1;
18629 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18630 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18631 if (default_face_p)
18632 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18633 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18634 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18635 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18636 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18638 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18640 it->override_ascent = -1;
18641 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18642 it->current_x = saved_x;
18643 it->object = saved_object;
18644 it->position = saved_pos;
18645 it->what = saved_what;
18646 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18647 it->len = saved_len;
18648 it->c = saved_c;
18649 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18650 return 1;
18654 return 0;
18658 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18659 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18660 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18661 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18662 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18663 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18665 static void
18666 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18668 struct face *face, *default_face;
18669 struct frame *f = it->f;
18671 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18672 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18673 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18674 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18675 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18676 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18677 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18678 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18679 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18680 return;
18682 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18683 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18685 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18686 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18687 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18688 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18689 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18690 else
18691 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18693 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18694 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18695 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18696 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18697 && !face->stipple
18698 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18699 return;
18701 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18702 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18703 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18705 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18706 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18707 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18708 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18709 text. */
18710 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18712 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18715 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18717 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18718 so that we know which face to draw. */
18719 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18721 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18722 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18723 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18725 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18726 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18728 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18729 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18730 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18731 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18732 glyphs. */
18733 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18734 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18735 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18736 struct glyph *g;
18737 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18738 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18739 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18741 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18742 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18743 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18744 if (stretch_width > 0)
18746 stretch_ascent =
18747 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18748 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18749 saved_pos = it->position;
18750 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18751 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18752 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18753 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18754 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18755 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18756 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18757 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18758 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18759 else
18760 it->face_id = face->id;
18761 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18762 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18763 it->position = saved_pos;
18764 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18765 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18768 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18770 else
18772 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18773 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18774 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18775 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18776 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18777 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18779 saved_object = it->object;
18780 saved_pos = it->position;
18782 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18783 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18784 it->object = make_number (0);
18785 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18786 it->len = 1;
18787 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18788 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18789 if the region ends at ZV. */
18790 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18791 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18792 else
18793 it->face_id = face->id;
18795 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18797 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18798 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18800 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18801 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18802 it->current_x = saved_x;
18803 it->object = saved_object;
18804 it->position = saved_pos;
18805 it->what = saved_what;
18806 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18811 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18812 trailing whitespace. */
18814 static int
18815 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18817 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18818 int c = 0;
18820 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18821 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18822 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18823 ++bytepos;
18825 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18827 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18828 return 1;
18830 return 0;
18834 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18836 static void
18837 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18839 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18841 if (used)
18843 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18844 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18846 if (row->reversed_p)
18848 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18849 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18850 glyph = start;
18851 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18854 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18855 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18856 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18857 and continuation glyphs. */
18858 if (!row->reversed_p)
18860 while (glyph >= start
18861 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18862 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18863 --glyph;
18865 else
18867 while (glyph <= start
18868 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18869 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18870 ++glyph;
18873 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18874 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18875 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18876 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18877 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18878 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18879 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18880 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18881 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18883 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18884 if (face_id < 0)
18885 return;
18887 if (!row->reversed_p)
18889 while (glyph >= start
18890 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18891 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18892 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18893 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18894 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18896 else
18898 while (glyph <= start
18899 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18900 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18901 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18902 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18903 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18910 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18911 used to hold the cursor. */
18913 static int
18914 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18916 int result = 1;
18918 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18919 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18921 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18922 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18923 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18924 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18925 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18926 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
18927 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
18928 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
18929 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18931 if (row->continued_p)
18932 result = 1;
18933 else
18935 /* Check for `display' property. */
18936 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18937 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18938 struct glyph *glyph;
18940 result = 0;
18941 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18942 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18944 Lisp_Object prop
18945 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18946 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18947 result =
18948 (!NILP (prop)
18949 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18950 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
18951 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
18952 even though this is not a display string. */
18953 if (!result)
18955 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
18957 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
18959 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
18961 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
18962 Qcursor, s)))
18964 result = 1;
18965 break;
18969 break;
18973 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18975 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18976 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18977 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18978 PT if PT is before the character. */
18979 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18980 result = row->continued_p;
18981 else
18982 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18983 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18984 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18985 after the ellipsis. */
18986 result = 0;
18988 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18989 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
18990 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18991 result = 1;
18992 else
18993 result = 0;
18996 return result;
19001 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
19002 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
19003 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
19004 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
19006 static int
19007 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19009 struct text_pos pos =
19010 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
19012 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
19013 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19014 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
19016 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
19017 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
19018 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
19019 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
19020 push_it (it, &pos);
19022 if (STRINGP (prop))
19024 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
19026 pop_it (it);
19027 return 0;
19030 it->string = prop;
19031 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
19032 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
19033 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
19034 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
19035 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
19036 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
19037 it->stop_charpos = 0;
19038 it->prev_stop = 0;
19039 it->base_level_stop = 0;
19041 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
19042 buffer/string. */
19043 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
19044 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
19045 else
19046 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19048 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19049 if (it->bidi_p)
19051 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19052 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19053 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19054 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19055 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19056 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19057 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19060 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19062 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19063 it->object = prop;
19065 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19066 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19068 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19069 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19070 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19072 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19073 else
19075 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19076 return 0;
19079 return 1;
19082 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19084 static Lisp_Object
19085 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19087 Lisp_Object position;
19089 if (STRINGP (it->object))
19090 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19091 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
19092 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19093 else
19094 return Qnil;
19096 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
19099 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19101 static void
19102 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19104 Lisp_Object prefix;
19106 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19108 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19109 if (NILP (prefix))
19110 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19112 else
19114 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19115 if (NILP (prefix))
19116 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19118 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19120 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19121 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19122 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19123 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19124 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19130 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19131 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19132 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19133 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19134 static void
19135 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19137 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19139 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19140 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19141 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19142 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19144 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19145 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19146 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19147 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19148 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19149 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19152 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19153 and ROW->maxpos. */
19154 static void
19155 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19156 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19157 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19159 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19160 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19162 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19163 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19164 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19165 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19166 else
19167 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19168 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19169 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19170 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19171 if (max_pos <= 0)
19173 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19174 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19177 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19178 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19180 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19181 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19182 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19183 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19184 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19185 Line is continued from string max_pos
19186 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19187 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19188 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19189 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19191 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19192 appropriate. */
19193 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19194 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19195 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19197 int seen_this_string = 0;
19198 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19200 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19201 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19202 /* this is not the first row */
19203 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19204 /* previous row is not the header line */
19205 && !r1->mode_line_p
19206 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19207 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19209 struct glyph *start, *end;
19211 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19212 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19213 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19214 other way round. */
19215 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19217 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19218 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19219 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19220 as their object. */
19221 while (end > start
19222 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19223 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19224 --end;
19225 if (end > start)
19227 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19228 seen_this_string = 1;
19230 else
19231 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19232 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19233 produced from a single newline, which is only
19234 possible if that newline came from the same string
19235 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19236 seen_this_string = 1;
19238 else
19240 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19241 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19242 while (end < start
19243 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19244 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19245 ++end;
19246 if (end < start)
19248 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19249 seen_this_string = 1;
19251 else
19252 seen_this_string = 1;
19255 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19256 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19257 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19258 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19260 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19261 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19262 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19263 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19264 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19265 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19266 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19267 have a much larger value. */
19268 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19269 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19270 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19272 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19273 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19274 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19275 else if (row->continued_p)
19277 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19278 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19279 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19280 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19281 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19282 starts at the next buffer position. */
19283 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19284 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19285 else
19287 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19288 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19291 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19292 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19293 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19294 the logical order. */
19295 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19296 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19297 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19298 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19299 else
19300 emacs_abort ();
19302 else
19303 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19306 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19307 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19308 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19309 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19310 only. */
19312 static int
19313 display_line (struct it *it)
19315 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19316 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19317 struct it wrap_it;
19318 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19319 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19320 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19321 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19322 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19323 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19324 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19325 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19326 int cvpos;
19327 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19328 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19330 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19331 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19333 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19334 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19336 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19337 fonts_changed_p = 1;
19338 return 0;
19341 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
19342 wset_region_showing (it->w, it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
19344 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19345 prepare_desired_row (row);
19347 row->y = it->current_y;
19348 row->start = it->start;
19349 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19350 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19351 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19352 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19354 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19355 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19356 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19357 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19358 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19359 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19361 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19362 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19363 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19364 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19366 enum move_it_result move_result;
19368 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19369 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19370 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19371 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19372 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19373 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19374 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19375 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19376 blank glyphs to produce. */
19377 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19378 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19379 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19380 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19382 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19383 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19384 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19385 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19386 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19387 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19388 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19389 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19390 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19392 else
19394 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19395 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19396 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19397 handle_line_prefix (it);
19400 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19401 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19402 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19403 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19404 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19405 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19406 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19408 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19409 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19410 do \
19412 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19413 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19414 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19415 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19416 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19417 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19418 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19419 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19420 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19422 min_pos = current_pos; \
19423 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19425 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19427 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19428 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19431 while (0)
19433 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19434 character to display. */
19435 while (1)
19437 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19438 int x, nglyphs;
19439 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19441 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19442 buffer reached. */
19443 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19445 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19446 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19447 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19448 to -1. */
19449 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19450 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19451 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19452 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19454 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19455 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19457 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
19458 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19459 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19460 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19463 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19464 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19465 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19466 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19467 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19468 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19469 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19470 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19471 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19472 background color. */
19473 if (row->reversed_p
19474 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19475 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19476 break;
19479 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19480 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19481 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19482 x = it->current_x;
19484 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19485 fit on the line. */
19486 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19488 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19489 descent = it->max_descent;
19490 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19491 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19493 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19495 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19496 may_wrap = 1;
19497 else if (may_wrap)
19499 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19500 wrap_x = x;
19501 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19502 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19503 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19504 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19505 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19506 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19507 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19508 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19509 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19510 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19511 may_wrap = 0;
19516 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19518 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19519 the next one. */
19520 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19522 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19523 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19524 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19525 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19526 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19527 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19528 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19529 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19530 continue;
19533 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19534 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19535 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19536 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19537 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19538 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19539 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19540 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19541 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19542 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19543 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19544 x_before = x;
19546 if (/* Not a newline. */
19547 nglyphs > 0
19548 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19549 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19551 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19552 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19553 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19554 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19555 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19556 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19557 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19558 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19559 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19560 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19561 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19562 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19563 if (it->bidi_p)
19564 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19566 else
19568 int i, new_x;
19569 struct glyph *glyph;
19571 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19573 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19574 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19576 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19577 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19578 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19579 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19580 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19581 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19582 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19583 && (row->reversed_p
19584 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19585 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19587 /* End of a continued line. */
19589 if (it->hpos == 0
19590 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19591 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19592 && (row->reversed_p
19593 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19594 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19596 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19597 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19598 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19599 after the glyph. */
19600 row->continued_p = 1;
19601 it->current_x = new_x;
19602 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19603 ++it->hpos;
19604 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19606 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19607 wrap point was found. */
19608 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19609 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19610 point, continue the line here as
19611 usual, if (i) the previous character
19612 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19613 current character is not. */
19614 && (!may_wrap
19615 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19616 goto back_to_wrap;
19618 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19619 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19620 displayed by this row. */
19621 if (it->bidi_p)
19622 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19623 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19624 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19626 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19628 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19629 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19630 row->continued_p = 0;
19631 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19633 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19635 row->continued_p = 0;
19636 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19640 else if (it->bidi_p)
19641 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19643 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19644 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19646 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19647 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19648 on the line. */
19649 if (row->reversed_p)
19650 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19651 - n_glyphs_before);
19652 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19654 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19655 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19656 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19657 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19658 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19660 row->continued_p = 1;
19661 it->current_x = x_before;
19662 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19664 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19665 element not fitting on the line. */
19666 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19667 it->max_descent = descent;
19668 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19669 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19671 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19673 back_to_wrap:
19674 if (row->reversed_p)
19675 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19676 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19677 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19678 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19679 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19680 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19681 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19682 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19683 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19684 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19685 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19686 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19687 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19688 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19689 row->continued_p = 1;
19690 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19691 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19692 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19694 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19695 up to the right margin of the window. */
19696 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19698 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19700 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19701 window. This produces a single glyph on
19702 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19703 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19704 consume the TAB. */
19705 if ((row->reversed_p
19706 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19707 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19708 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19709 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19710 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19711 row->continued_p = 1;
19712 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19713 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19715 else
19717 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19718 the right edge of the window. Restore
19719 positions to values before the element. */
19720 if (row->reversed_p)
19721 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19722 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19723 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19725 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19726 it->current_x = x_before;
19727 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19728 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19729 || (row->reversed_p
19730 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19731 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19732 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19733 row->continued_p = 1;
19735 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19737 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19739 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19740 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19743 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19744 element not fitting on the line. */
19745 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19746 it->max_descent = descent;
19747 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19748 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19751 break;
19753 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19755 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19756 ++it->hpos;
19758 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19759 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19760 this row. */
19761 if (it->bidi_p)
19762 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19764 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19765 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19766 negative X position. */
19767 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19769 else
19771 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19772 window. This should not happen because of the
19773 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19774 function, unless the text display area of the
19775 window is empty. */
19776 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19779 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19780 we want to record its position. */
19781 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19782 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19784 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19785 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19786 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19787 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19788 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19789 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19790 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19792 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19793 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19794 break;
19797 at_end_of_line:
19798 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19799 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19800 margin of the window. */
19801 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19803 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19805 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19807 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19808 display the cursor there. */
19809 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19810 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19812 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19813 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19815 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19816 if (used_before == 0)
19817 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19819 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19820 find_row_edges. */
19821 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19823 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19824 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19825 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19826 break;
19829 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19830 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19831 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19833 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19834 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19835 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19836 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19837 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19838 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19840 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19841 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19842 || (row->reversed_p
19843 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19844 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19846 int i, n;
19848 if (!row->reversed_p)
19850 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19851 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19852 break;
19854 else
19856 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19857 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19858 break;
19859 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19860 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19861 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19862 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19863 last glyph added to ROW. */
19864 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19865 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19866 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19869 it->current_x = x_before;
19870 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19872 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19874 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19875 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19878 else
19880 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19881 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19884 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19886 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19887 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19889 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19890 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19891 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19892 break;
19894 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19896 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19897 goto at_end_of_line;
19899 it->current_x = x_before;
19902 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19903 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19904 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19905 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19906 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19907 break;
19911 if (wrap_data)
19912 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19914 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19915 at the left window margin. */
19916 if (it->first_visible_x
19917 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19919 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19920 || (row->reversed_p
19921 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19922 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19923 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19924 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19927 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19929 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19930 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19931 where these positions are determined. */
19932 row->end = it->current;
19933 if (!it->bidi_p)
19935 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19936 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19938 else
19940 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19941 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19942 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19943 row, so we must determine them now. */
19944 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19947 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19948 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19949 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19950 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19951 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19952 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19953 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19955 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19956 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19958 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19959 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19960 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19961 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19962 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19963 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19965 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19966 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19967 *p++ = *glyph++;
19969 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19970 p2 = p;
19971 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19972 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19973 ++p2;
19974 if (p2 > p)
19976 while (p2 < end)
19977 *p++ = *p2++;
19978 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19981 else
19983 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19984 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19986 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19989 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
19990 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
19991 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
19993 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
19994 compute_line_metrics (it);
19996 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
19997 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
19998 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
19999 structure. */
20001 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
20002 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
20003 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
20004 && it->ellipsis_p);
20006 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
20007 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
20008 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
20009 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
20010 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
20012 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20013 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20014 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
20015 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
20017 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
20018 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
20019 if ((cvpos < 0
20020 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
20021 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
20022 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
20023 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
20024 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
20025 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
20026 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
20027 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
20028 || (it->bidi_p
20029 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
20030 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
20031 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
20032 && cursor_row_p (row))
20033 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
20035 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
20036 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
20037 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
20038 row to be used. */
20039 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
20040 it->current_y += row->height;
20041 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
20042 ++it->vpos;
20043 ++it->glyph_row;
20044 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
20045 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
20046 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
20047 the flag accordingly. */
20048 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20049 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20050 it->start = row->end;
20051 return row->displays_text_p;
20053 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20056 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20057 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20058 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20059 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20060 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20062 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20063 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20064 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20065 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20067 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20068 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20070 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20071 struct buffer *old = buf;
20073 if (! NILP (buffer))
20075 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20076 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20079 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20080 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20081 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20082 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20083 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20084 return Qleft_to_right;
20085 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20086 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20087 else
20089 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20090 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20091 enough as it is. */
20092 struct bidi_it itb;
20093 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20094 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20095 int c;
20096 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20098 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20099 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20100 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20101 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20102 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20103 the previous non-empty line. */
20104 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20106 pos--;
20107 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
20109 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20110 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20112 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20113 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20115 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20116 break;
20117 bytepos--;
20118 pos--;
20120 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20121 bytepos--;
20123 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20124 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20125 itb.string.s = NULL;
20126 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20127 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20128 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20129 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20130 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20131 set_buffer_temp (old);
20132 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20134 case L2R:
20135 return Qleft_to_right;
20136 break;
20137 case R2L:
20138 return Qright_to_left;
20139 break;
20140 default:
20141 emacs_abort ();
20148 /***********************************************************************
20149 Menu Bar
20150 ***********************************************************************/
20152 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20154 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20155 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20157 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20158 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20159 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20160 for the menu bar. */
20162 static void
20163 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20165 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20166 struct it it;
20167 Lisp_Object items;
20168 int i;
20170 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20171 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20172 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20173 return;
20174 #endif
20175 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20176 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20177 return;
20178 #endif
20180 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20181 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20182 return;
20183 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20185 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
20186 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20187 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20188 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20189 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20190 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20191 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20193 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20194 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20195 struct window *menu_w;
20196 eassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
20197 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20198 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20199 MENU_FACE_ID);
20200 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20201 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20203 else
20205 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20206 pixel x/y. */
20207 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20208 MENU_FACE_ID);
20209 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20210 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20212 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20214 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20215 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20216 this. */
20217 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20219 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20220 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20222 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20223 clear_glyph_row (row);
20224 row->enabled_p = 1;
20225 row->full_width_p = 1;
20228 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20229 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20230 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20232 Lisp_Object string;
20234 /* Stop at nil string. */
20235 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20236 if (NILP (string))
20237 break;
20239 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20240 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20242 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20243 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20244 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20245 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20248 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20249 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20250 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20252 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20253 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20258 /***********************************************************************
20259 Mode Line
20260 ***********************************************************************/
20262 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20263 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20264 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20265 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20267 static int
20268 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
20270 int nwindows = 0;
20272 while (!NILP (window))
20274 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20276 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
20277 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
20278 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
20279 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
20280 else if (force
20281 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20282 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20284 struct text_pos lpoint;
20285 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20287 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20288 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20289 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
20291 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20292 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20293 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20295 struct text_pos pt;
20297 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20298 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
20299 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
20300 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
20301 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
20302 else
20303 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20306 /* Display mode lines. */
20307 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20308 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20310 ++nwindows;
20311 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
20314 /* Restore old settings. */
20315 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20316 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20319 window = w->next;
20322 return nwindows;
20326 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20327 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20329 static int
20330 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20332 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
20333 int n = 0;
20335 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20336 selected_frame = w->frame;
20337 old_selected_window = selected_window;
20338 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
20340 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
20341 line_number_displayed = 0;
20342 wset_column_number_displayed (w, Qnil);
20344 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
20346 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
20348 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
20349 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
20350 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
20351 ++n;
20354 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
20356 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
20357 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
20358 ++n;
20361 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
20362 selected_window = old_selected_window;
20363 return n;
20367 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
20368 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
20369 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
20370 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
20371 displayed. */
20373 static int
20374 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
20376 struct it it;
20377 struct face *face;
20378 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20380 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20381 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
20382 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
20383 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
20384 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
20386 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
20388 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
20389 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
20390 made up of many separate strings. */
20391 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20393 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20394 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
20396 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
20398 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
20399 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
20400 values. */
20401 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20402 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
20403 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20404 pop_kboard ();
20406 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20408 /* Fill up with spaces. */
20409 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
20411 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20412 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
20413 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
20414 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
20415 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
20417 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
20418 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
20419 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
20420 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
20422 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20423 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
20424 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
20427 return it.glyph_row->height;
20430 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
20431 Return the updated list. */
20433 static Lisp_Object
20434 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
20436 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
20437 register Lisp_Object tem;
20439 tail = list;
20440 prev = Qnil;
20441 while (CONSP (tail))
20443 tem = XCAR (tail);
20445 if (EQ (elt, tem))
20447 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
20448 if (NILP (prev))
20449 list = XCDR (tail);
20450 else
20451 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
20453 /* Now make it the first. */
20454 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
20455 return tail;
20457 else
20458 prev = tail;
20459 tail = XCDR (tail);
20460 QUIT;
20463 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
20464 return list;
20467 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
20468 translates into text depends on its data type.
20470 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
20472 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
20473 infinite recursion here.
20475 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
20476 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
20477 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
20478 display_string for details.
20480 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
20482 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
20484 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
20485 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
20487 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
20488 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
20489 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
20491 static int
20492 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
20493 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
20495 int n = 0, field, prec;
20496 int literal = 0;
20498 tail_recurse:
20499 if (depth > 100)
20500 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
20502 depth++;
20504 switch (XTYPE (elt))
20506 case Lisp_String:
20508 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
20509 unsigned char c;
20510 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
20512 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
20513 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
20515 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
20516 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
20518 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
20519 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
20520 is risky, do that anyway. */
20522 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
20524 /* If the starting string has properties,
20525 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
20526 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
20528 Lisp_Object tem;
20530 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
20531 tem = props;
20532 while (CONSP (tem))
20534 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
20535 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
20536 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
20538 props = oprops;
20541 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20542 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
20544 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
20545 without consing. */
20546 elt = XCAR (aelt);
20547 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20548 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20550 else
20552 Lisp_Object tem;
20554 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
20555 so get rid of it. */
20556 if (! NILP (aelt))
20557 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20558 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20560 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
20561 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
20562 props, elt);
20563 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
20564 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20565 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
20566 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20567 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
20568 to at most 50 elements. */
20569 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
20570 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20571 if (! NILP (tem))
20572 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
20577 offset = 0;
20579 if (literal)
20581 prec = precision - n;
20582 switch (mode_line_target)
20584 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20585 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20586 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
20587 break;
20588 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20589 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
20590 break;
20591 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20592 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
20593 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20594 break;
20597 break;
20600 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
20602 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
20603 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
20604 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
20605 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
20607 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
20609 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
20610 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
20613 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
20615 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
20617 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
20618 is length of string. Don't output more than
20619 PRECISION allows us. */
20620 offset--;
20622 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
20623 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
20624 &nchars, &nbytes);
20626 switch (mode_line_target)
20628 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20629 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20630 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20631 break;
20632 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20634 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20635 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20636 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
20637 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20638 : charpos + nchars);
20640 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20641 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20642 make_number (endpos)),
20643 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20645 break;
20646 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20648 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20649 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20651 if (precision <= 0)
20652 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20653 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20654 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20655 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20657 break;
20660 else /* c == '%' */
20662 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
20664 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20665 don't pad. */
20666 field = 0;
20667 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20668 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20670 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20671 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20672 field = field_width - n;
20674 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20675 prec = precision - n;
20677 if (c == 'M')
20678 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20679 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20680 risky);
20681 else if (c != 0)
20683 int multibyte;
20684 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
20685 const char *spec;
20686 Lisp_Object string;
20688 bytepos = percent_position;
20689 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20690 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20691 : bytepos);
20692 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20693 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20695 switch (mode_line_target)
20697 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20698 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20699 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20700 break;
20701 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20703 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20704 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20705 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20706 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20708 break;
20709 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20711 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20713 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20714 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20715 charpos, 0, it,
20716 field, prec, 0,
20717 multibyte);
20719 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20720 string where the `%x' came from, position
20721 of the `%'. */
20722 if (nwritten > 0)
20724 struct glyph *glyph
20725 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20726 + nglyphs_before);
20727 int i;
20729 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20731 glyph[i].object = elt;
20732 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20735 n += nwritten;
20738 break;
20741 else /* c == 0 */
20742 break;
20746 break;
20748 case Lisp_Symbol:
20749 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20750 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20751 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20752 literally. */
20754 register Lisp_Object tem;
20756 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20757 then its contents are risky to use. */
20758 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20759 risky = 1;
20761 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20762 if (!NILP (tem))
20764 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20765 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20766 don't check for % within it. */
20767 if (STRINGP (tem))
20768 literal = 1;
20770 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20772 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20773 elt = tem;
20774 goto tail_recurse;
20778 break;
20780 case Lisp_Cons:
20782 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20784 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20785 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20786 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20787 and effectively concatenate them.
20788 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20789 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20790 to at least that many characters.
20791 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20792 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20793 car = XCAR (elt);
20794 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20796 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20797 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20799 if (risky)
20800 break;
20802 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20804 Lisp_Object spec;
20805 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20806 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20807 precision - n, spec, props,
20808 risky);
20811 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20813 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20814 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20816 if (risky)
20817 break;
20819 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20820 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20821 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20822 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20824 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20826 tem = Fboundp (car);
20827 elt = XCDR (elt);
20828 if (!CONSP (elt))
20829 goto invalid;
20830 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20831 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20832 if (!NILP (tem))
20834 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20835 if (!NILP (tem))
20837 elt = XCAR (elt);
20838 goto tail_recurse;
20841 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20842 Get the cddr of the original list
20843 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20844 elt = XCDR (elt);
20845 if (NILP (elt))
20846 break;
20847 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20848 goto invalid;
20849 elt = XCAR (elt);
20850 goto tail_recurse;
20852 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20854 register int lim = XINT (car);
20855 elt = XCDR (elt);
20856 if (lim < 0)
20858 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20859 if (precision <= 0)
20860 precision = -lim;
20861 else
20862 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20864 else if (lim > 0)
20866 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20867 current maximum. */
20868 if (precision > 0)
20869 lim = min (precision, lim);
20871 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20872 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20873 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20874 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20876 goto tail_recurse;
20878 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20880 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20881 int len = 0;
20883 while (CONSP (elt)
20884 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20886 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20887 /* Do padding only after the last
20888 element in the list. */
20889 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20890 ? field_width - n
20891 : 0),
20892 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20893 props, risky);
20894 elt = XCDR (elt);
20895 len++;
20896 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20897 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20898 /* Check for cycle. */
20899 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20900 break;
20904 break;
20906 default:
20907 invalid:
20908 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20909 goto tail_recurse;
20912 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20913 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20915 switch (mode_line_target)
20917 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20918 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20919 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20920 break;
20921 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20922 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20923 break;
20924 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20925 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20926 0, 0, 0);
20927 break;
20931 return n;
20934 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20936 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20937 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20939 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20940 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20941 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20943 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20944 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20946 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20947 properties to the string.
20949 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20950 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20953 static int
20954 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20955 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20957 ptrdiff_t len;
20958 int n = 0;
20960 if (string != NULL)
20962 len = strlen (string);
20963 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20964 len = precision;
20965 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20966 if (NILP (props))
20967 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20968 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20970 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20971 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20972 if (NILP (face))
20973 face = mode_line_string_face;
20974 else
20975 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20976 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20978 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20979 props, lisp_string);
20981 else
20983 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20984 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20986 len = precision;
20987 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20988 precision = -1;
20990 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20992 Lisp_Object face;
20993 if (NILP (props))
20994 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
20995 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20996 if (NILP (face))
20997 face = mode_line_string_face;
20998 else
20999 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
21000 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
21001 if (copy_string)
21002 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
21004 if (!NILP (props))
21005 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
21006 props, lisp_string);
21009 if (len > 0)
21011 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21012 n += len;
21015 if (field_width > len)
21017 field_width -= len;
21018 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
21019 if (!NILP (props))
21020 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
21021 props, lisp_string);
21022 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
21023 n += field_width;
21026 return n;
21030 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
21031 1, 4, 0,
21032 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
21033 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
21034 for details) to use.
21036 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
21038 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
21039 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
21040 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21041 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21042 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21043 An integer value means the value string has no text
21044 properties.
21046 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21047 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21048 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21049 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21050 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21052 struct it it;
21053 int len;
21054 struct window *w;
21055 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21056 int face_id;
21057 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21058 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21059 Lisp_Object str;
21060 int string_start = 0;
21062 w = decode_any_window (window);
21063 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
21065 if (NILP (buffer))
21066 buffer = w->buffer;
21067 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21069 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21070 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21071 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21072 return empty_unibyte_string;
21074 if (no_props)
21075 face = Qnil;
21077 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21078 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21079 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21080 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21081 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21082 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21083 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21084 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21086 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21088 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21089 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21090 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21091 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21092 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)),
21093 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21094 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21096 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21097 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21099 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21101 if (no_props)
21103 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21104 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21105 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21106 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21108 else
21110 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21111 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21112 mode_line_string_face = face;
21113 mode_line_string_face_prop
21114 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
21117 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21118 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21119 pop_kboard ();
21121 if (no_props)
21123 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21124 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21126 else
21128 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21129 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21130 empty_unibyte_string);
21133 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21134 return str;
21137 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21138 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21140 static void
21141 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21143 register char *p = buf;
21145 if (d <= 0)
21146 *p++ = '0';
21147 else
21149 while (d > 0)
21151 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21152 d /= 10;
21156 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21157 *p++ = ' ';
21158 *p-- = '\0';
21159 while (p > buf)
21161 d = *buf;
21162 *buf++ = *p;
21163 *p-- = d;
21167 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21168 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21169 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21171 static const char power_letter[] =
21173 0, /* no letter */
21174 'k', /* kilo */
21175 'M', /* mega */
21176 'G', /* giga */
21177 'T', /* tera */
21178 'P', /* peta */
21179 'E', /* exa */
21180 'Z', /* zetta */
21181 'Y' /* yotta */
21184 static void
21185 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21187 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21188 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21189 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21190 int remainder = 0;
21191 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21192 int tenths = -1;
21193 int exponent = 0;
21195 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21196 int length;
21198 char * psuffix;
21199 char * p;
21201 if (1000 <= quotient)
21203 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21206 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21207 quotient /= 1000;
21208 exponent++;
21210 while (1000 <= quotient);
21212 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21213 if (quotient <= 9)
21215 tenths = remainder / 100;
21216 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
21218 if (tenths < 9)
21219 tenths++;
21220 else
21222 quotient++;
21223 if (quotient == 10)
21224 tenths = -1;
21225 else
21226 tenths = 0;
21230 else
21231 if (500 <= remainder)
21233 if (quotient < 999)
21234 quotient++;
21235 else
21237 quotient = 1;
21238 exponent++;
21239 tenths = 0;
21244 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21245 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21246 if (quotient <= 9)
21247 length = 1;
21248 else
21249 length = 2;
21250 else
21251 length = 3;
21252 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21254 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21255 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21256 *psuffix = '\0';
21258 /* Print TENTHS. */
21259 if (tenths >= 0)
21261 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21262 *--p = '.';
21265 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21268 int digit = quotient % 10;
21269 *--p = '0' + digit;
21271 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21273 /* Print leading spaces. */
21274 while (buf < p)
21275 *--p = ' ';
21278 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21279 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21280 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21282 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21284 static char *
21285 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21287 Lisp_Object val;
21288 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21289 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21290 int eol_str_len;
21291 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21292 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21294 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21295 eoltype = Qnil;
21297 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21299 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21300 if (eol_flag)
21301 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21302 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21304 else
21306 Lisp_Object attrs;
21307 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21309 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21310 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21312 *buf++ = multibyte
21313 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21314 : ' ';
21316 if (eol_flag)
21318 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21320 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21321 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21322 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21323 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21324 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21325 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21326 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21327 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21328 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
21332 if (eol_flag)
21334 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
21335 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
21337 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
21338 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
21340 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
21342 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
21343 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
21344 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
21345 eol_str = tmp;
21347 else
21349 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
21350 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
21352 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
21353 buf += eol_str_len;
21356 return buf;
21359 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
21360 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
21361 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
21362 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
21364 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
21365 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
21367 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
21369 static const char *
21370 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
21371 Lisp_Object *string)
21373 Lisp_Object obj;
21374 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
21375 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
21376 /* We are going to use f->decode_mode_spec_buffer as the buffer to
21377 produce strings from numerical values, so limit preposterously
21378 large values of FIELD_WIDTH to avoid overrunning the buffer's
21379 end. The size of the buffer is enough for FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE
21380 bytes plus the terminating null. */
21381 int width = min (field_width, FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f));
21382 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
21384 obj = Qnil;
21385 *string = Qnil;
21387 switch (c)
21389 case '*':
21390 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21391 return "%";
21392 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21393 return "*";
21394 return "-";
21396 case '+':
21397 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
21398 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21399 return "*";
21400 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21401 return "%";
21402 return "-";
21404 case '&':
21405 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
21406 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21407 return "*";
21408 return "-";
21410 case '%':
21411 return "%";
21413 case '[':
21415 int i;
21416 char *p;
21418 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21419 return "[[[... ";
21420 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21421 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21422 *p++ = '[';
21423 *p = 0;
21424 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21427 case ']':
21429 int i;
21430 char *p;
21432 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21433 return " ...]]]";
21434 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21435 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21436 *p++ = ']';
21437 *p = 0;
21438 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21441 case '-':
21443 register int i;
21445 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
21446 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
21447 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
21448 return "--";
21449 if (field_width <= 0
21450 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
21452 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
21453 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
21454 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
21455 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21457 else
21458 return lots_of_dashes;
21461 case 'b':
21462 obj = BVAR (b, name);
21463 break;
21465 case 'c':
21466 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
21467 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
21468 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
21469 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
21470 even crash emacs.) */
21471 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21472 return "";
21473 else
21475 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
21476 wset_column_number_displayed (w, make_number (col));
21477 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, col);
21478 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21481 case 'e':
21482 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
21484 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
21485 return "";
21486 else
21487 return "!MEM FULL! ";
21489 #else
21490 return "";
21491 #endif
21493 case 'F':
21494 /* %F displays the frame name. */
21495 if (!NILP (f->title))
21496 return SSDATA (f->title);
21497 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21498 return SSDATA (f->name);
21499 return "Emacs";
21501 case 'f':
21502 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
21503 break;
21505 case 'i':
21507 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21508 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21509 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21512 case 'I':
21514 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21515 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, size);
21516 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21519 case 'l':
21521 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
21522 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
21523 ptrdiff_t junk;
21525 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
21526 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21527 return "";
21529 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
21530 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
21531 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
21533 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
21534 don't forget that too fast. */
21535 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
21536 goto no_value;
21537 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
21538 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
21539 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21541 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
21542 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
21543 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
21545 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21546 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21547 goto no_value;
21550 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
21551 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
21552 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
21554 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
21555 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
21556 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
21558 else
21560 line = 1;
21561 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
21562 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21565 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
21566 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
21567 startpos_byte,
21568 startpos, &junk);
21570 topline = nlines + line;
21572 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
21573 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
21574 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
21575 go back past it. */
21576 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21578 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline));
21579 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BUF_BEGV (b)));
21581 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
21582 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21584 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
21585 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21586 ptrdiff_t position;
21587 ptrdiff_t distance =
21588 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
21590 if (startpos - distance > limit)
21592 limit = startpos - distance;
21593 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
21596 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21597 limit_byte,
21598 - (height * 2 + 30),
21599 &position);
21600 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
21601 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
21602 give up on line numbers for this window. */
21603 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
21605 wset_base_line_pos (w, w->buffer);
21606 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21607 goto no_value;
21610 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline - nlines));
21611 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position)));
21614 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
21615 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21616 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
21618 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
21619 line_number_displayed = 1;
21621 /* Make the string to show. */
21622 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, width, topline + nlines);
21623 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21624 no_value:
21626 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21627 int pad = width - 2;
21628 while (pad-- > 0)
21629 *p++ = ' ';
21630 *p++ = '?';
21631 *p++ = '?';
21632 *p = '\0';
21633 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21636 break;
21638 case 'm':
21639 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21640 break;
21642 case 'n':
21643 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21644 return " Narrow";
21645 break;
21647 case 'p':
21649 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
21650 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21652 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21654 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21655 return "All";
21656 else
21657 return "Bottom";
21659 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21660 return "Top";
21661 else
21663 if (total > 1000000)
21664 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21665 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21666 else
21667 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21668 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21669 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21670 if (total == 100)
21671 total = 99;
21672 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21673 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21677 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21678 case 'P':
21680 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21681 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21682 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21684 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21686 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21687 return "All";
21688 else
21689 return "Bottom";
21691 else
21693 if (total > 1000000)
21694 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21695 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21696 else
21697 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21698 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21699 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21700 if (total == 100)
21701 total = 99;
21702 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21703 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
21704 else
21705 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21706 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21710 case 's':
21711 /* status of process */
21712 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21713 if (NILP (obj))
21714 return "no process";
21715 #ifndef MSDOS
21716 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21717 #endif
21718 break;
21720 case '@':
21722 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21723 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21724 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21725 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21727 if (NILP (val))
21728 return "-";
21729 else
21730 return "@";
21733 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21734 return "T";
21736 case 'z':
21737 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21738 case 'Z':
21739 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21741 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21742 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21744 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21746 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21747 to do EOL conversion. */
21748 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21749 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21750 p, 0);
21751 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21752 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21753 p, 0);
21755 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21756 p, eol_flag);
21758 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21759 #ifdef subprocesses
21760 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21761 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21763 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21764 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21765 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21766 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21768 #endif /* subprocesses */
21769 #endif /* 0 */
21770 *p = 0;
21771 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21775 if (STRINGP (obj))
21777 *string = obj;
21778 return SSDATA (obj);
21780 else
21781 return "";
21785 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21786 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21787 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21789 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21791 static ptrdiff_t
21792 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
21793 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
21794 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
21796 register unsigned char *cursor;
21797 unsigned char *base;
21799 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
21800 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21801 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
21803 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21804 check only for newlines. */
21805 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21806 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21808 if (count > 0)
21810 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21812 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21813 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21814 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21815 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21816 while (1)
21818 if (selective_display)
21819 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21821 else
21822 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21825 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21827 if (--count == 0)
21829 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21830 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21831 return orig_count;
21833 else
21834 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21835 break;
21837 else
21838 break;
21840 start_byte += cursor - base;
21843 else
21845 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21847 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21848 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21849 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21850 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21851 while (1)
21853 if (selective_display)
21854 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21855 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21857 else
21858 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21861 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21863 if (++count == 0)
21865 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21866 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21867 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21868 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21869 return - orig_count - 1;
21872 else
21873 break;
21875 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21876 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21877 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21881 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21883 if (count < 0)
21884 return - orig_count + count;
21885 return orig_count - count;
21891 /***********************************************************************
21892 Displaying strings
21893 ***********************************************************************/
21895 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21897 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21898 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21899 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21900 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21901 ignoring its text properties.
21903 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21904 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21905 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21907 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21908 standard display table, temporarily.
21910 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21911 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21912 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21913 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21915 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21916 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21918 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21920 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21921 ----------------------------------------
21922 -1 -1 %s
21923 -1 10 %.10s
21924 10 -1 %10s
21925 20 10 %20.10s
21927 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21928 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21929 enable_multibyte_characters.
21931 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21933 static int
21934 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21935 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
21936 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21938 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21939 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21940 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21941 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
21943 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21944 with index START. */
21945 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21946 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21947 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21948 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21949 ignore its text properties. */
21950 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21952 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21953 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21954 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21956 ptrdiff_t endptr;
21957 struct face *face;
21959 it->face_id
21960 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21961 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21962 it->region_end_charpos,
21963 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21964 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21965 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21968 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21969 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21970 if (max_x <= 0)
21971 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21972 else
21973 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21975 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21976 hscrolled. */
21977 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21978 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21979 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21981 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21982 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21983 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21984 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21985 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21987 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21988 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21989 else
21990 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21992 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
21993 past last_visible_x. */
21994 while (it->current_x < max_x)
21996 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
21998 /* Get the next display element. */
21999 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
22000 break;
22002 /* Produce glyphs. */
22003 x_before = it->current_x;
22004 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
22005 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
22007 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
22008 i = 0;
22009 x = x_before;
22010 while (i < nglyphs)
22012 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
22014 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
22015 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
22017 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
22018 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
22020 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
22021 if (row->reversed_p)
22022 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22023 - n_glyphs_before);
22024 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
22025 it->current_x = x_before;
22027 else
22029 if (row->reversed_p)
22030 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
22031 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
22032 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
22033 it->current_x = x;
22035 break;
22037 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
22039 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
22040 ++it->hpos;
22041 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
22042 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22044 else
22046 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22047 Should not happen. */
22048 emacs_abort ();
22051 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22052 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22053 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22054 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22055 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22056 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22057 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22058 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22059 ++i;
22062 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22063 if (i < nglyphs)
22064 break;
22066 /* Stop at line ends. */
22067 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22069 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22070 break;
22073 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22074 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22075 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22076 else
22077 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22079 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22080 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22081 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22083 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22084 truncated at a padding space. */
22085 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22087 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22089 int ii, n;
22091 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22093 if (!row->reversed_p)
22095 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22096 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22097 break;
22099 else
22101 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22102 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22103 break;
22104 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22105 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22107 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22109 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22110 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22113 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22115 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22117 break;
22121 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22122 if (it->first_visible_x
22123 && it_charpos > 0)
22125 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22126 || (row->reversed_p
22127 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22128 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22129 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22130 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22133 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22135 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22136 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22141 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22142 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22143 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22144 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22145 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22146 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22147 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22150 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22152 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22154 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22156 register Lisp_Object tem;
22157 tem = XCAR (tail);
22158 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22159 return 1;
22160 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22161 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22164 if (CONSP (propval))
22166 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22168 Lisp_Object propelt;
22169 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22170 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22172 register Lisp_Object tem;
22173 tem = XCAR (tail);
22174 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22175 return 1;
22176 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22177 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22182 return 0;
22185 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22186 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22187 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22188 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22189 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22190 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22191 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22192 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22193 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22195 Lisp_Object prop
22196 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22197 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22198 : pos_or_prop);
22199 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22200 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22201 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22202 : make_number (invis));
22205 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22206 the following elements:
22208 SPEC ::=
22209 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22210 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22211 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22212 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22213 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22214 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22215 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22216 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22218 NUM ::=
22219 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22220 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22222 UNIT ::=
22223 in - pixels per inch *)
22224 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22225 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22226 width - width of current font in pixels.
22227 height - height of current font in pixels.
22229 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22231 ELEMENT ::=
22233 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22234 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22236 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22237 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22239 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22241 Examples:
22243 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22244 (5 . in)
22246 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22247 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22249 Align to first text column (in header line):
22250 '(space :align-to 0)
22252 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22253 containing a loaded image:
22254 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22256 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22257 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22259 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22260 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22262 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22263 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22265 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22266 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22267 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22268 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22272 #define NUMVAL(X) \
22273 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
22274 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
22275 : - 1)
22277 static int
22278 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22279 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22281 double pixels;
22283 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22284 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22286 if (NILP (prop))
22287 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22289 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22291 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22293 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22295 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22297 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22298 pixels = 1.0;
22299 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22300 pixels = 25.4;
22301 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22302 pixels = 2.54;
22303 else
22304 pixels = 0;
22305 if (pixels > 0)
22307 double ppi;
22308 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22309 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22310 && (ppi = (width_p
22311 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
22312 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
22313 ppi > 0))
22314 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22315 #endif
22317 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
22318 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
22319 && (ppi = (width_p
22320 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
22321 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
22322 ppi > 0)))
22323 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22325 return 0;
22329 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22330 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22331 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22332 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22333 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22334 #else
22335 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22336 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22337 #endif
22339 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22340 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22341 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22342 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22344 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22346 *res = 0;
22347 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22348 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22349 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
22350 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22351 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
22352 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22353 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
22354 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22355 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22356 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
22357 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22358 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22359 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22360 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22361 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22362 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22363 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22364 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22365 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
22366 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22367 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
22369 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22370 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22371 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22372 : 0)));
22374 else
22376 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22377 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22378 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22379 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22380 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22381 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22382 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22383 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22384 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22385 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
22388 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->buffer);
22389 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
22390 prop = Qnil;
22393 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
22395 int base_unit = (width_p
22396 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
22397 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22398 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
22401 if (CONSP (prop))
22403 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
22404 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
22406 if (SYMBOLP (car))
22408 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22409 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22410 && valid_image_p (prop))
22412 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
22413 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
22415 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
22417 #endif
22418 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
22420 int first = 1;
22421 double px;
22423 pixels = 0;
22424 while (CONSP (cdr))
22426 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
22427 font, width_p, align_to))
22428 return 0;
22429 if (first)
22430 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
22431 else
22432 pixels += px;
22433 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
22435 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
22436 pixels = -pixels;
22437 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22440 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->buffer);
22441 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
22442 car = Qnil;
22445 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
22447 double fact;
22448 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
22449 if (NILP (cdr))
22450 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22451 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
22452 font, width_p, align_to))
22453 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
22454 return 0;
22457 return 0;
22460 return 0;
22464 /***********************************************************************
22465 Glyph Display
22466 ***********************************************************************/
22468 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22470 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
22472 void
22473 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22475 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
22476 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
22477 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
22478 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
22479 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
22480 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
22481 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
22482 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
22483 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
22484 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
22485 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
22486 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
22489 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
22491 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
22492 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
22493 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
22494 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
22495 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
22496 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
22497 face-override for drawing S. */
22499 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22500 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
22501 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
22502 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
22503 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
22504 #endif
22506 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
22507 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
22508 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
22509 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
22510 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
22511 #endif
22513 static void
22514 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
22515 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
22516 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
22517 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
22519 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
22520 s->w = w;
22521 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
22522 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22523 s->hdc = hdc;
22524 #endif
22525 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
22526 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
22527 s->char2b = char2b;
22528 s->hl = hl;
22529 s->row = row;
22530 s->area = area;
22531 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
22532 s->height = row->height;
22533 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
22534 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
22538 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
22539 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
22541 static void
22542 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22543 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22545 if (h)
22547 if (*head)
22548 (*tail)->next = h;
22549 else
22550 *head = h;
22551 h->prev = *tail;
22552 *tail = t;
22557 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
22558 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
22559 result. */
22561 static void
22562 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22563 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22565 if (h)
22567 if (*head)
22568 (*head)->prev = t;
22569 else
22570 *tail = t;
22571 t->next = *head;
22572 *head = h;
22577 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
22578 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
22580 static void
22581 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22582 struct glyph_string *s)
22584 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
22585 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
22589 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
22590 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
22591 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
22592 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
22593 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
22595 static struct face *
22596 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
22597 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
22599 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
22601 if (face->font)
22603 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
22605 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22606 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22607 else
22608 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22611 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22612 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
22613 if (display_p)
22614 #endif
22616 eassert (face != NULL);
22617 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22620 return face;
22624 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
22625 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
22626 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
22628 static struct face *
22629 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
22630 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
22632 struct face *face;
22634 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
22635 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
22637 if (two_byte_p)
22638 *two_byte_p = 0;
22640 if (face->font)
22642 unsigned code;
22644 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22645 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22646 else
22647 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22649 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22650 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22651 else
22652 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22655 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22656 eassert (face != NULL);
22657 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22658 return face;
22662 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22663 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22665 static int
22666 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22668 unsigned code;
22670 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22671 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22672 else
22673 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22675 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22676 return 0;
22677 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22678 return 1;
22682 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22684 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22685 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22687 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22688 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22690 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22692 static int
22693 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22694 int overlaps)
22696 int i;
22697 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22698 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22699 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22700 struct face *face;
22702 eassert (s);
22704 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22705 s->face = NULL;
22706 s->font = NULL;
22707 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22709 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22711 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22712 on the left or right. */
22713 if (c != '\t')
22715 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22716 -1, Qnil);
22718 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22719 s->char2b + i, 1);
22720 if (face)
22722 if (! s->face)
22724 s->face = face;
22725 s->font = s->face->font;
22727 else if (s->face != face)
22728 break;
22731 ++s->nchars;
22733 s->cmp_to = i;
22735 if (s->face == NULL)
22737 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
22738 s->font = s->face->font;
22741 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22742 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22743 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22745 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22746 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22747 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22748 characters of the glyph string. */
22749 if (s->font == NULL)
22751 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22752 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22755 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22756 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22758 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22759 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22761 return s->cmp_to;
22764 static int
22765 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22766 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22768 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22769 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22770 int i;
22772 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22773 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22774 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22775 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22776 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22777 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22778 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22779 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22780 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22781 glyph++;
22782 while (glyph < last
22783 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22784 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22785 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22786 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22788 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22790 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22791 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22793 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22795 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22796 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22800 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22801 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22802 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22805 static int
22806 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22807 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22809 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22810 int voffset;
22812 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22813 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22814 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22815 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22816 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22817 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22818 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22819 s->nchars = 1;
22820 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22821 glyph++;
22822 while (glyph < last
22823 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22824 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22825 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22827 s->nchars++;
22828 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22829 glyph++;
22831 s->ybase += voffset;
22832 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22836 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22838 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22839 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22840 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22841 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22843 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22845 static int
22846 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22847 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22849 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22850 int voffset;
22851 int glyph_not_available_p;
22853 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22854 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
22855 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22857 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22858 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22859 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22860 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22861 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22862 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22864 while (glyph < last
22865 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22866 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22867 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22868 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22869 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22871 int two_byte_p;
22873 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22874 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22875 &two_byte_p);
22876 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22877 ++s->nchars;
22878 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22879 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22880 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22881 break;
22884 s->font = s->face->font;
22886 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22887 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22888 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22889 characters of the glyph string. */
22890 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22892 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22893 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22896 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22897 s->ybase += voffset;
22899 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22900 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22904 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22906 static void
22907 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22909 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22910 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22911 eassert (s->img);
22912 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22913 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22914 s->font = s->face->font;
22915 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22917 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22918 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22922 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22924 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22925 END is the index of the last + 1.
22927 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22929 static int
22930 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22932 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22933 int voffset, face_id;
22935 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22937 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22938 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22939 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22940 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22941 s->font = s->face->font;
22942 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22943 s->nchars = 1;
22944 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22946 for (++glyph;
22947 (glyph < last
22948 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22949 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22950 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22951 ++glyph)
22952 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22954 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22955 s->ybase += voffset;
22957 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22958 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22959 eassert (s->face);
22960 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22963 static struct font_metrics *
22964 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22966 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22967 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22969 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22970 return NULL;
22971 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22972 return &metrics;
22975 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22976 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22977 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22978 assumed to be zero. */
22980 void
22981 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22983 *left = *right = 0;
22985 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22987 struct face *face;
22988 XChar2b char2b;
22989 struct font_metrics *pcm;
22991 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
22992 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
22994 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
22995 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
22996 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
22997 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
23000 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
23002 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
23004 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
23006 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
23007 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
23008 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
23009 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
23011 else
23013 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
23014 struct font_metrics metrics;
23016 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
23017 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
23018 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
23019 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
23020 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
23021 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
23027 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23028 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
23029 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
23031 static int
23032 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23034 int k;
23036 if (s->left_overhang)
23038 int x = 0, i;
23039 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23040 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23042 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23043 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23045 k = i + 1;
23047 else
23048 k = -1;
23050 return k;
23054 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23055 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23056 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23058 static int
23059 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23061 int i, k, x;
23062 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23063 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23065 k = -1;
23066 x = 0;
23067 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23069 int left, right;
23070 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23071 if (x + right > 0)
23072 k = i;
23073 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23076 return k;
23080 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23081 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23082 no such glyph is found. */
23084 static int
23085 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23087 int k = -1;
23089 if (s->right_overhang)
23091 int x = 0, i;
23092 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23093 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23094 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23095 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23097 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23098 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23100 k = i;
23103 return k;
23107 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23108 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23109 if no such glyph is found. */
23111 static int
23112 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23114 int i, k, x;
23115 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23116 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23117 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs
23118 + (s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH ? 1 : s->nchars));
23120 k = -1;
23121 x = 0;
23122 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23124 int left, right;
23125 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23126 if (x - left < 0)
23127 k = i;
23128 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23131 return k;
23135 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23136 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23137 in the drawing area. */
23139 static void
23140 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23142 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23143 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23145 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23146 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23147 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23148 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23149 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23150 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23151 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23152 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23154 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23155 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23156 area. */
23157 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23158 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23159 else
23160 s->background_width = s->width;
23164 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23165 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23166 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23168 static void
23169 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23171 if (backward_p)
23173 while (s)
23175 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23176 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23177 x -= s->width;
23178 s->x = x;
23179 s = s->prev;
23182 else
23184 while (s)
23186 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23187 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23188 s->x = x;
23189 x += s->width;
23190 s = s->next;
23197 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23198 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23199 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23200 as well as the following local variables:
23201 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23203 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23204 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23205 init_glyph_string. */
23206 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23207 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23208 #else
23209 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23210 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23211 #endif
23213 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23214 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23215 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23216 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23217 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23218 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23219 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23221 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23222 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23223 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23224 do \
23226 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23227 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23228 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23229 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23230 s->x = (X); \
23232 while (0)
23235 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23236 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23237 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23238 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23239 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23240 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23241 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23243 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23244 do \
23246 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23247 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23248 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23249 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23250 ++START; \
23251 s->x = (X); \
23253 while (0)
23256 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23257 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23258 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23259 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23260 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23261 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23262 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23263 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23265 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23266 do \
23268 int face_id; \
23269 XChar2b *char2b; \
23271 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23273 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23274 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23275 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23276 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23277 s->x = (X); \
23278 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23280 while (0)
23283 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23284 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23285 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23286 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23287 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23288 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23289 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23290 x-position of the drawing area. */
23292 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23293 do { \
23294 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23295 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23296 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23297 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23298 XChar2b *char2b; \
23299 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23300 int n; \
23302 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23304 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23305 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23306 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23308 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23309 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23310 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23311 s->cmp = cmp; \
23312 s->cmp_from = n; \
23313 s->x = (X); \
23314 if (n == 0) \
23315 first_s = s; \
23316 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23319 ++START; \
23320 s = first_s; \
23321 } while (0)
23324 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23325 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23327 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23328 do { \
23329 int face_id; \
23330 XChar2b *char2b; \
23331 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23333 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23334 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23335 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23336 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23337 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23338 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23339 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23340 s->x = (X); \
23341 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23342 } while (0)
23345 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23346 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
23347 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
23349 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23350 do \
23352 int face_id; \
23354 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23356 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23357 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23358 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23359 s->x = (X); \
23360 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
23361 overlaps); \
23363 while (0)
23366 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
23367 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
23368 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
23369 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
23370 x-positions of the drawing area.
23372 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
23373 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
23374 asynchronously). */
23376 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23377 do \
23379 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
23380 while (START < END) \
23382 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
23383 switch (first_glyph->type) \
23385 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
23386 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23387 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23388 break; \
23390 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
23391 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
23392 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23393 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23394 else \
23395 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23396 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23397 break; \
23399 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
23400 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23401 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23402 break; \
23404 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
23405 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23406 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23407 break; \
23409 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
23410 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23411 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23412 break; \
23414 default: \
23415 emacs_abort (); \
23418 if (s) \
23420 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
23421 (X) += s->width; \
23424 } while (0)
23427 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
23428 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
23429 face-override with the following meaning:
23431 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
23432 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
23433 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
23434 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
23435 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
23436 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
23438 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
23439 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
23440 the overlapping part to be drawn:
23442 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
23443 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
23444 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
23445 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
23447 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
23449 static int
23450 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
23451 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
23452 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
23454 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
23455 struct glyph_string *s;
23456 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
23457 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
23458 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
23459 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
23461 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
23463 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
23464 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
23465 start = max (0, start);
23466 start = min (end, start);
23468 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
23469 end of the drawing area. */
23470 if (row->full_width_p)
23472 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
23473 or fringes. */
23474 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
23475 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
23477 else
23479 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
23480 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
23482 x += area_left;
23484 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
23485 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
23486 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
23487 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
23488 i = start;
23489 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
23490 if (tail)
23491 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
23492 else
23493 x_reached = x;
23495 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
23496 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
23497 strings built above. */
23498 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
23500 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
23501 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
23502 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
23503 int check_mouse_face = 0;
23504 int dummy_x = 0;
23506 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
23507 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
23508 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p
23509 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row >= 0
23510 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= 0)
23512 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
23514 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
23515 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
23517 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
23519 check_mouse_face = 1;
23520 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
23521 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
23522 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
23523 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
23524 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
23528 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
23529 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23530 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23531 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23533 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23534 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
23535 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
23536 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
23537 draws over it. */
23538 i = left_overwritten (head);
23539 if (i >= 0)
23541 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23543 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
23544 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
23545 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
23546 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
23547 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
23548 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
23549 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
23550 if (check_mouse_face
23551 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23552 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23553 else
23554 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23556 j = i;
23557 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
23558 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23559 start = i;
23560 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23561 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23562 clip_head = head;
23565 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23566 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
23567 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
23568 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
23569 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
23570 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
23571 strings exist. */
23572 i = left_overwriting (head);
23573 if (i >= 0)
23575 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23577 if (check_mouse_face
23578 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23579 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23580 else
23581 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23583 clip_head = head;
23584 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
23585 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23586 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23587 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23588 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23589 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23592 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23593 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
23594 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
23595 over it. */
23596 i = right_overwritten (tail);
23597 if (i >= 0)
23599 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23601 if (check_mouse_face
23602 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23603 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23604 else
23605 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23607 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23608 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23609 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
23610 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
23611 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23612 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23613 clip_tail = tail;
23616 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23617 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
23618 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
23619 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
23620 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
23621 i = right_overwriting (tail);
23622 if (i >= 0)
23624 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23625 if (check_mouse_face
23626 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23627 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23628 else
23629 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23631 clip_tail = tail;
23632 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
23633 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23634 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23635 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23636 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23637 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23638 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23640 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
23641 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23643 s->clip_head = clip_head;
23644 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
23648 /* Draw all strings. */
23649 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23650 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23652 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23653 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23654 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23655 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23656 && !row->full_width_p
23657 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23658 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23659 completely. */
23660 && !overlaps)
23662 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23663 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23664 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23665 x0 -= area_left;
23666 x1 -= area_left;
23668 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23669 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23671 #endif
23673 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23674 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23675 if (row->full_width_p)
23676 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23677 else
23678 x_reached -= area_left;
23680 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23682 return x_reached;
23685 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23686 is not present. */
23688 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23690 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23691 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23692 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23694 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23695 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23699 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23700 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23702 static void
23703 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23705 struct glyph *glyph;
23706 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23708 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23709 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23711 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23712 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23714 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23715 rather than append it. */
23716 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23718 struct glyph *g;
23720 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23721 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23722 g[1] = *g;
23723 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23725 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23726 glyph->object = it->object;
23727 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23729 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23730 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23732 else
23734 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23735 be displayed correctly. */
23736 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23737 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23739 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23740 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23741 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23742 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23743 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23744 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23745 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23746 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23747 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23748 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23749 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23750 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23751 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23752 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23753 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23754 if (it->bidi_p)
23756 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23757 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23758 emacs_abort ();
23759 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23761 else
23763 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23764 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23766 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23768 else
23769 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23772 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23773 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23774 non-null. */
23776 static void
23777 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23779 struct glyph *glyph;
23780 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23782 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23784 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23785 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23787 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23788 rather than append it. */
23789 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23791 struct glyph *g;
23793 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23794 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23795 g[1] = *g;
23796 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23798 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23799 glyph->object = it->object;
23800 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23801 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23802 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23803 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23804 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23805 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23807 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23808 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23809 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23811 else
23813 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23814 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23815 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23816 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23818 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23819 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23820 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23821 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23822 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23823 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23824 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23825 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23826 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23827 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23828 if (it->bidi_p)
23830 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23831 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23832 emacs_abort ();
23833 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23835 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23837 else
23838 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23842 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23843 IT->voffset. */
23845 static void
23846 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23848 if (it->voffset)
23850 if (it->voffset < 0)
23851 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23852 in the line. */
23853 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23854 else
23855 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23856 in the line. */
23857 it->descent += it->voffset;
23862 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23863 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23864 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23866 static void
23867 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23869 struct image *img;
23870 struct face *face;
23871 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23872 struct glyph_slice slice;
23874 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23876 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23877 eassert (face);
23878 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23879 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23881 if (it->image_id < 0)
23883 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23884 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23885 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23886 it->pixel_width = 0;
23887 it->nglyphs = 0;
23888 return;
23891 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23892 eassert (img);
23893 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23894 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23896 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23897 slice.width = img->width;
23898 slice.height = img->height;
23900 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23901 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23902 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23903 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23905 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23906 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23907 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23908 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23910 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23911 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23912 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23913 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23915 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23916 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23917 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23918 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23920 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23921 slice.x = img->width;
23922 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23923 slice.y = img->height;
23924 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23925 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23926 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23927 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23929 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23930 return;
23932 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23934 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23935 if (slice.y == 0)
23936 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23937 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23938 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23939 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23941 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23942 if (slice.x == 0)
23943 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23944 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23945 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23947 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23948 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23949 if (it->descent < 0)
23950 it->descent = 0;
23952 it->nglyphs = 1;
23954 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23956 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23958 if (slice.y == 0)
23959 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23960 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23961 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23964 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23965 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23966 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23967 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23970 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23972 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23973 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23974 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23975 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23977 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23978 slice.width -= crop;
23981 if (it->glyph_row)
23983 struct glyph *glyph;
23984 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23986 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23987 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23989 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23990 glyph->object = it->object;
23991 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23992 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
23993 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23994 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23995 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
23996 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23997 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23998 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23999 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24000 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24001 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24002 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24003 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24004 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
24005 glyph->slice.img = slice;
24006 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24007 if (it->bidi_p)
24009 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24010 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24011 emacs_abort ();
24012 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24014 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24016 else
24017 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24022 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
24023 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
24024 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
24026 static void
24027 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
24028 int width, int height, int ascent)
24030 struct glyph *glyph;
24031 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24033 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
24035 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24036 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24038 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24039 rather than append it. */
24040 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24042 struct glyph *g;
24044 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24045 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24046 g[1] = *g;
24047 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24049 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24050 glyph->object = object;
24051 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24052 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24053 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24054 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24055 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24056 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24057 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24058 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24059 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24060 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24061 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24062 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24063 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24064 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24065 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24066 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24067 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24068 if (it->bidi_p)
24070 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24071 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24072 emacs_abort ();
24073 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24075 else
24077 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24078 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24080 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24082 else
24083 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24086 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24088 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24089 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24090 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24091 being recognized:
24093 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24094 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24095 point number.
24097 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24098 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24099 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24101 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24102 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24104 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24106 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24107 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24109 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24110 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24111 the glyph property.
24113 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24115 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24116 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24117 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24119 void
24120 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24122 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24123 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24124 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24125 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24126 double tem;
24127 struct font *font = NULL;
24129 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24130 int ascent = 0;
24131 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24133 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24135 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24136 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24137 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24139 #endif
24141 /* List should start with `space'. */
24142 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24143 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24145 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24146 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24147 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24149 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24150 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24151 width = (int)tem;
24153 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24154 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24155 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24157 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24158 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24159 property. */
24160 struct it it2;
24161 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24163 it2 = *it;
24164 if (it->multibyte_p)
24165 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24166 else
24168 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24169 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24170 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24173 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24174 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24175 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24176 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24178 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24179 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24180 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24182 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24183 align_to = (align_to < 0
24185 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24186 else if (align_to < 0)
24187 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24188 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24189 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24191 else
24192 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24193 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24195 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24196 width = 1;
24198 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24199 /* Compute height. */
24200 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24202 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24203 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24205 height = (int)tem;
24206 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24208 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24209 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24210 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24211 else
24212 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24214 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24215 height = 1;
24217 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24218 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24219 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24220 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24221 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24222 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24223 else if (!NILP (prop)
24224 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24225 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24226 else
24227 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24229 else
24230 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24231 height = 1;
24233 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24234 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24236 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24237 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24238 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24239 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24240 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24241 #endif
24244 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24246 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24247 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24248 int n = width;
24250 if (!STRINGP (object))
24251 object = it->w->buffer;
24252 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24253 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24254 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24255 else
24256 #endif
24258 it->object = object;
24259 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24260 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24261 while (n--)
24262 tty_append_glyph (it);
24263 it->object = o_object;
24267 it->pixel_width = width;
24268 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24269 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24271 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24272 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24273 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24274 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24276 else
24277 #endif
24278 it->nglyphs = width;
24281 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24282 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24283 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24284 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24285 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24287 static void
24288 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24290 struct it temp_it;
24291 Lisp_Object gc;
24292 GLYPH glyph;
24294 temp_it = *it;
24295 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24296 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24298 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24300 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24301 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24302 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24303 else
24304 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24305 if (it->dp
24306 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24308 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24309 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24310 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24313 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
24315 /* Truncation glyph. */
24316 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
24317 if (it->dp
24318 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24320 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24321 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24322 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24325 else
24326 emacs_abort ();
24328 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24329 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
24330 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
24331 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
24332 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
24333 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
24334 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
24335 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
24336 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
24337 glyphs. */
24338 && temp_it.glyph_row
24339 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
24340 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
24341 width. */
24342 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
24343 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
24344 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
24345 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
24347 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
24349 if (stretch_width > 0)
24351 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
24352 struct font *font =
24353 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
24354 int stretch_ascent =
24355 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
24356 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24358 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
24359 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
24360 stretch_ascent);
24363 #endif
24365 temp_it.dp = NULL;
24366 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24367 temp_it.len = 1;
24368 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
24369 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
24370 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
24372 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
24373 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
24374 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
24377 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24379 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
24380 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
24381 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
24382 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
24383 height of specified face font.
24385 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
24388 static Lisp_Object
24389 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
24390 int boff, int override)
24392 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
24393 int ascent, descent, height;
24395 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
24396 return val;
24398 if (CONSP (val))
24400 face_name = XCAR (val);
24401 val = XCDR (val);
24402 if (!NUMBERP (val))
24403 val = make_number (1);
24404 if (NILP (face_name))
24406 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24407 goto scale;
24411 if (NILP (face_name))
24413 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24414 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
24416 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
24418 override = 0;
24420 else
24422 int face_id;
24423 struct face *face;
24425 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
24426 if (face_id < 0)
24427 return make_number (-1);
24429 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24430 font = face->font;
24431 if (font == NULL)
24432 return make_number (-1);
24433 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24434 if (font->vertical_centering)
24435 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24438 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24439 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24441 if (override)
24443 it->override_ascent = ascent;
24444 it->override_descent = descent;
24445 it->override_boff = boff;
24448 height = ascent + descent;
24450 scale:
24451 if (FLOATP (val))
24452 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
24453 else if (INTEGERP (val))
24454 height *= XINT (val);
24456 return make_number (height);
24460 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
24461 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
24462 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
24464 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
24465 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
24466 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
24467 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
24468 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
24470 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
24472 static void
24473 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
24474 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
24475 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
24477 struct glyph *glyph;
24478 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24480 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24481 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24483 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24484 rather than append it. */
24485 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24487 struct glyph *g;
24489 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24490 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24491 g[1] = *g;
24492 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24494 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24495 glyph->object = it->object;
24496 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24497 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24498 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24499 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24500 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
24501 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
24502 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
24503 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
24504 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
24505 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
24506 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
24507 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
24508 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
24509 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24510 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24511 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24512 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24513 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24514 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24515 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24516 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24517 glyph->face_id = face_id;
24518 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24519 if (it->bidi_p)
24521 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24522 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24523 emacs_abort ();
24524 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24526 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24528 else
24529 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24533 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
24534 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
24535 the character. See the description of enum
24536 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
24538 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
24539 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
24540 for the character. */
24542 static void
24543 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
24545 int face_id;
24546 struct face *face;
24547 struct font *font;
24548 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
24549 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
24550 int len;
24552 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
24553 ASCII face. */
24554 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
24555 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24556 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
24557 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
24558 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24559 base_width = font->average_width;
24561 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
24562 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
24563 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
24564 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
24566 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
24568 else
24570 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
24571 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
24572 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
24573 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
24574 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
24577 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
24579 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
24580 len = 0;
24581 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24583 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
24585 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
24586 if (width == 0)
24587 width = 1;
24588 else if (width > 4)
24589 width = 4;
24590 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
24591 len = 0;
24592 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24594 else
24596 char buf[7];
24597 const char *str;
24598 unsigned int code[6];
24599 int upper_len;
24600 int ascent, descent;
24601 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
24603 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24604 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24605 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24607 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
24609 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
24610 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
24611 if (CONSP (acronym))
24612 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
24613 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
24615 else
24617 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
24618 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
24619 str = buf;
24621 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
24622 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
24623 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
24624 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
24625 &metrics_upper);
24626 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
24627 &metrics_lower);
24631 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
24632 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
24633 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
24634 if (base_width >= width)
24636 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
24637 it->pixel_width = base_width;
24638 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
24640 else
24642 /* Center the shorter one. */
24643 it->pixel_width = width;
24644 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
24645 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
24646 else
24648 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
24649 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
24650 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
24651 lower_xoff = 0;
24652 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
24656 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
24657 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
24658 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
24659 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
24660 /* Center vertically.
24661 H:base_height, D:base_descent
24662 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
24664 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
24665 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
24666 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
24667 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
24668 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
24669 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
24670 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
24671 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
24672 - metrics_upper.descent);
24673 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
24674 if (height > base_height)
24676 it->ascent = ascent;
24677 it->descent = descent;
24681 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24682 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24683 if (it->glyph_row)
24684 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
24685 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
24686 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
24687 it->nglyphs = 1;
24688 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24692 /* RIF:
24693 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
24694 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
24695 for an overview of struct it. */
24697 void
24698 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
24700 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
24702 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24704 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
24706 XChar2b char2b;
24707 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24708 struct font *font = face->font;
24709 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
24710 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24712 if (font == NULL)
24714 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
24715 the method specified in the first extra slot of
24716 Vglyphless_char_display. */
24717 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
24719 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
24720 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
24721 goto done;
24724 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24725 if (font->vertical_centering)
24726 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24728 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
24730 int stretched_p;
24732 it->nglyphs = 1;
24734 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24736 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24737 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24738 boff = it->override_boff;
24740 else
24742 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24743 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24746 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24748 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24749 if (pcm->width == 0
24750 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24751 pcm = NULL;
24754 if (pcm)
24756 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24757 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24758 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24760 else
24762 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24763 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24764 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24765 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24768 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24770 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24772 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24773 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24775 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24777 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24778 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24780 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24781 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24782 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24785 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24786 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24787 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24788 if (stretched_p)
24789 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24791 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24792 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24793 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24794 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24796 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24798 if (thick > 0)
24800 it->ascent += thick;
24801 it->descent += thick;
24803 else
24804 thick = -thick;
24806 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24807 it->pixel_width += thick;
24808 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24809 it->pixel_width += thick;
24812 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24813 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24814 if (face->overline_p)
24815 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24817 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24819 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24820 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24821 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24822 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24825 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24827 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24828 if (it->glyph_row)
24830 if (stretched_p)
24832 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24833 into a stretch glyph. */
24834 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24835 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24836 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24837 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24839 else
24840 append_glyph (it);
24842 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24843 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24844 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24845 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24846 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24848 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24849 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24850 width. */
24851 it->pixel_width = 1;
24853 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24855 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24856 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24857 don't increase that height */
24859 Lisp_Object height;
24860 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24862 it->override_ascent = -1;
24863 it->pixel_width = 0;
24864 it->nglyphs = 0;
24866 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24867 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24868 if (CONSP (height)
24869 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24870 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24872 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24873 height = XCAR (height);
24875 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24877 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24879 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24880 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24881 boff = it->override_boff;
24883 else
24885 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24886 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24889 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24891 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24893 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24894 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24896 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24898 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24899 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24901 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24902 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24903 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24904 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24906 else
24908 Lisp_Object spacing;
24910 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24911 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24913 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24914 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24915 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24917 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24918 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24920 if (!NILP (height)
24921 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24922 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24924 if (!NILP (total_height))
24925 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24926 else
24928 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24929 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24931 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24933 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24934 if (!NILP (total_height))
24935 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24939 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24941 if (font->space_width > 0)
24943 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24944 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24945 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24947 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24948 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24949 tab stop after that. */
24950 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24951 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24953 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24954 it->nglyphs = 1;
24955 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24956 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24958 if (it->glyph_row)
24960 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24961 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24964 else
24966 it->pixel_width = 0;
24967 it->nglyphs = 1;
24971 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24973 /* A static composition.
24975 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24976 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24978 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24979 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24980 the overall glyphs composed). */
24981 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24982 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24983 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24984 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24985 struct font *font = face->font;
24987 it->nglyphs = 1;
24989 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
24990 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
24991 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
24992 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
24993 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
24994 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
24995 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
24996 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
24998 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
24999 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
25000 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
25001 than these, respectively. */
25002 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
25003 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25004 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
25005 int lbearing, rbearing;
25006 int i, width, ascent, descent;
25007 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
25008 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
25009 XChar2b char2b;
25010 struct font_metrics *pcm;
25011 int font_not_found_p;
25012 ptrdiff_t pos;
25014 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
25015 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
25016 break;
25017 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
25018 right_padded = 1;
25019 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
25021 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
25022 break;
25023 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25025 if (i > 0)
25026 left_padded = 1;
25028 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
25029 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
25030 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
25031 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
25032 if (font_not_found_p)
25034 face = face->ascii_face;
25035 font = face->font;
25037 boff = font->baseline_offset;
25038 if (font->vertical_centering)
25039 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
25040 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
25041 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
25042 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
25044 cmp->font = font;
25046 pcm = NULL;
25047 if (! font_not_found_p)
25049 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25050 &char2b, 0);
25051 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25054 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25055 if (pcm)
25057 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25058 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25059 descent = pcm->descent;
25060 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25061 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25063 else
25065 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25066 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25067 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25068 lbearing = 0;
25069 rbearing = width;
25072 rightmost = width;
25073 leftmost = 0;
25074 lowest = - descent + boff;
25075 highest = ascent + boff;
25077 if (! font_not_found_p
25078 && font->default_ascent
25079 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25080 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25081 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25082 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25084 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25085 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25086 at the left. */
25087 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25088 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25089 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25090 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25092 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25093 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25095 int left, right, btm, top;
25096 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25097 int face_id;
25098 struct face *this_face;
25100 if (ch == '\t')
25101 ch = ' ';
25102 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25103 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25104 font = this_face->font;
25106 if (font == NULL)
25107 pcm = NULL;
25108 else
25110 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25111 &char2b, 0);
25112 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25114 if (! pcm)
25115 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25116 else
25118 width = pcm->width;
25119 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25120 descent = pcm->descent;
25121 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25122 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25123 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25125 /* Relative composition with or without
25126 alternate chars. */
25127 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25128 btm = - descent + boff;
25129 if (font->relative_compose
25130 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25131 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25132 make_number (ch)))))
25135 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25136 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25137 btm = highest + 1;
25138 else if (ascent <= 0)
25139 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25140 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25143 else
25145 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25146 value that encodes global and new reference
25147 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25148 specified by numbers as below:
25150 0---1---2 -- ascent
25154 9--10--11 -- center
25156 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25158 6---7---8 -- descent
25160 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25161 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25163 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25164 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25165 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25166 if (xoff)
25167 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25168 if (yoff)
25169 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25171 left = (leftmost
25172 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25173 - nrefx * width / 2
25174 + xoff);
25176 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25177 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25178 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25179 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25180 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25181 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25182 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25183 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25184 + yoff);
25187 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25188 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25190 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25191 if (width > 0)
25193 right = left + width;
25194 if (left < leftmost)
25195 leftmost = left;
25196 if (right > rightmost)
25197 rightmost = right;
25199 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25200 if (top > highest)
25201 highest = top;
25202 if (btm < lowest)
25203 lowest = btm;
25205 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25206 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25207 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25208 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25212 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25213 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25214 non-negative. */
25215 if (leftmost < 0)
25217 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25218 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25219 rightmost -= leftmost;
25220 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25221 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25224 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25226 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25227 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25228 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25229 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25230 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25232 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25234 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25237 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25238 cmp->ascent = highest;
25239 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25240 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25241 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25242 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25243 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25246 if (it->glyph_row
25247 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25248 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25249 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25251 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25252 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25253 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25254 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25256 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25258 if (thick > 0)
25260 it->ascent += thick;
25261 it->descent += thick;
25263 else
25264 thick = - thick;
25266 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25267 it->pixel_width += thick;
25268 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25269 it->pixel_width += thick;
25272 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25273 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25274 if (face->overline_p)
25275 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25277 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25278 if (it->ascent < 0)
25279 it->ascent = 0;
25280 if (it->descent < 0)
25281 it->descent = 0;
25283 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25284 append_composite_glyph (it);
25286 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25288 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25289 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25290 Lisp_Object gstring;
25291 struct font_metrics metrics;
25293 it->nglyphs = 1;
25295 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25296 it->pixel_width
25297 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25298 &metrics);
25299 if (it->glyph_row
25300 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25301 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25302 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25303 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25304 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25306 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25308 if (thick > 0)
25310 it->ascent += thick;
25311 it->descent += thick;
25313 else
25314 thick = - thick;
25316 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25317 it->pixel_width += thick;
25318 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25319 it->pixel_width += thick;
25321 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25322 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25323 if (face->overline_p)
25324 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25325 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25326 if (it->ascent < 0)
25327 it->ascent = 0;
25328 if (it->descent < 0)
25329 it->descent = 0;
25331 if (it->glyph_row)
25332 append_composite_glyph (it);
25334 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
25335 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
25336 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
25337 produce_image_glyph (it);
25338 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
25339 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
25341 done:
25342 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
25343 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
25344 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
25345 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
25346 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
25348 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
25350 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
25351 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
25352 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
25355 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
25356 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
25357 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
25358 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
25361 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25362 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
25363 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
25364 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
25365 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
25366 row being updated. */
25368 void
25369 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25371 int x, hpos, chpos = updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos;
25373 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25374 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25375 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25376 margin in that case. */
25377 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
25378 chpos = 0;
25379 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25380 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25382 block_input ();
25384 /* Write glyphs. */
25386 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
25387 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
25388 updated_row, updated_area,
25389 hpos, hpos + len,
25390 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25392 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
25393 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
25394 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
25395 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
25396 && chpos >= hpos
25397 && chpos < hpos + len)
25398 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25400 unblock_input ();
25402 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25403 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25404 output_cursor.x = x;
25408 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25409 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
25411 void
25412 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25414 struct frame *f;
25415 struct window *w;
25416 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
25417 struct glyph_row *row;
25418 struct glyph *glyph;
25419 int frame_x, frame_y;
25420 ptrdiff_t hpos;
25422 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25423 block_input ();
25424 w = updated_window;
25425 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25427 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
25428 row = updated_row;
25429 line_height = row->height;
25431 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
25432 shift_by_width = 0;
25433 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
25434 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
25436 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
25437 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
25438 - output_cursor.x
25439 - shift_by_width);
25441 /* Shift right. */
25442 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
25443 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
25445 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
25446 line_height, shift_by_width);
25448 /* Write the glyphs. */
25449 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
25450 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
25451 hpos, hpos + len,
25452 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25454 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25455 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25456 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
25457 unblock_input ();
25461 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25462 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
25463 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
25464 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
25466 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
25467 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
25469 void
25470 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
25472 struct frame *f;
25473 struct window *w = updated_window;
25474 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
25475 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
25477 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25478 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25480 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25481 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
25482 else
25483 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
25484 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25486 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
25487 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
25488 if (to_x == 0)
25489 return;
25490 else if (to_x < 0)
25491 to_x = max_x;
25492 else
25493 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
25495 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
25497 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
25498 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
25499 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
25500 output_cursor.x, -1,
25501 updated_row->y,
25502 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
25504 from_x = output_cursor.x;
25506 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
25507 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25509 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
25510 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
25512 else
25514 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
25515 from_x += area_left;
25516 to_x += area_left;
25519 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25520 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
25521 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
25523 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
25524 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
25526 block_input ();
25527 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
25528 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
25529 unblock_input ();
25533 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25537 /***********************************************************************
25538 Cursor types
25539 ***********************************************************************/
25541 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
25542 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
25543 of the bar cursor. */
25545 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25546 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
25548 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
25550 if (NILP (arg))
25551 return NO_CURSOR;
25553 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
25554 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
25556 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
25557 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25559 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
25561 *width = 2;
25562 return BAR_CURSOR;
25565 if (CONSP (arg)
25566 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
25567 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25569 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25570 return BAR_CURSOR;
25573 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
25575 *width = 2;
25576 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25579 if (CONSP (arg)
25580 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
25581 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25583 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25584 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25587 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
25588 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
25589 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
25590 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25592 return type;
25595 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
25596 void
25597 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
25599 int width = 1;
25600 Lisp_Object tem;
25602 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
25603 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25605 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
25607 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
25608 if (!NILP (tem))
25610 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
25611 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
25612 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25614 else
25615 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25619 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25621 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
25622 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
25623 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
25624 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
25626 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
25627 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
25628 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
25629 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
25630 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
25632 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25633 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
25634 int *active_cursor)
25636 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25637 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
25638 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25639 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
25640 int non_selected = 0;
25642 *active_cursor = 1;
25644 /* Echo area */
25645 if (cursor_in_echo_area
25646 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
25647 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
25649 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
25651 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25653 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25654 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25656 else
25657 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25660 *active_cursor = 0;
25661 non_selected = 1;
25664 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
25665 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
25666 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
25668 *active_cursor = 0;
25670 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
25671 return NO_CURSOR;
25673 non_selected = 1;
25676 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
25677 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25678 return NO_CURSOR;
25680 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
25681 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
25683 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25684 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25686 else
25687 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25689 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
25690 for non-selected window or frame. */
25691 if (non_selected)
25693 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
25694 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
25695 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
25696 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
25697 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25698 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25699 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
25700 --*width;
25701 return cursor_type;
25704 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
25705 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
25707 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
25709 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25711 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
25712 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
25713 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
25714 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
25715 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
25717 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
25718 where N = size of default frame font size.
25719 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
25720 if (!img->mask
25721 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
25722 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
25723 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25726 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
25728 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
25729 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
25730 not a solid box cursor. */
25731 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25734 return cursor_type;
25737 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
25739 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
25740 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
25741 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
25743 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
25744 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
25746 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25747 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25750 #if 0
25751 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25752 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25753 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25755 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25756 filled box <-> hollow box
25757 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25758 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25759 other type <-> no cursor */
25761 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25762 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25764 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25766 *width = 1;
25767 return cursor_type;
25769 #endif
25771 return NO_CURSOR;
25775 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25776 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25777 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25778 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25779 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25780 are window-relative. */
25782 static void
25783 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25784 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25786 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25787 struct glyph_row *row;
25789 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25790 return;
25791 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25792 return;
25794 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25795 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25796 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25797 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25798 return;
25800 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25802 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25803 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25804 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25805 return;
25808 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25809 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25810 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25811 return;
25813 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25814 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25815 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25816 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25817 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25818 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25819 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25820 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25821 over the cursor image.
25823 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25824 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25825 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25826 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25827 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25829 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25830 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25831 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25832 return;
25834 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25837 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25840 /************************************************************************
25841 Mouse Face
25842 ************************************************************************/
25844 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25846 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25847 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25848 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25850 void
25851 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25852 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25854 int i, x;
25856 block_input ();
25858 x = 0;
25859 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25861 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25863 int start = i, start_x = x;
25867 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25868 ++i;
25870 while (i < row->used[area]
25871 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25873 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25874 start, i,
25875 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25877 else
25879 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25880 ++i;
25884 unblock_input ();
25888 /* EXPORT:
25889 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25890 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25892 void
25893 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25894 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25896 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25897 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25898 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25899 if ((row->reversed_p
25900 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25901 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25903 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25904 int x1;
25905 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25907 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
25908 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
25909 window margin in that case. */
25910 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25911 hpos = 0;
25912 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25913 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25915 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
25916 hl, 0);
25917 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25919 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25920 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25921 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25922 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25923 are redrawn. */
25924 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25926 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25928 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25929 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25930 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25931 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25933 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25934 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25935 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25936 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25942 /* EXPORT:
25943 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25945 void
25946 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25948 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25949 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25950 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25951 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25952 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25953 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25954 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25955 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25956 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25958 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25959 screen. */
25960 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25961 goto mark_cursor_off;
25963 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25964 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25965 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25966 goto mark_cursor_off;
25968 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25969 can do. */
25970 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25971 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25972 goto mark_cursor_off;
25974 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25975 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25976 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25977 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25979 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25980 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25981 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25982 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25983 goto mark_cursor_off;
25985 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25986 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25988 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25989 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
25990 goto mark_cursor_off;
25993 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
25994 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
25995 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
25996 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
25997 cursor glyph at hand. */
25998 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
25999 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
26000 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
26001 goto mark_cursor_off;
26003 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26004 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26005 margin in that case. */
26006 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26007 hpos = 0;
26008 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26009 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26011 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
26012 we clear the cursor. */
26013 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26014 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
26015 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
26016 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
26017 mouse highlighting does not. */
26018 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
26019 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
26021 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
26022 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
26024 int x, y, left_x;
26025 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
26026 int width;
26028 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
26029 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
26030 goto mark_cursor_off;
26032 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
26033 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
26034 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
26035 if (x < left_x)
26036 width -= left_x - x;
26037 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
26038 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
26039 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
26041 if (width > 0)
26042 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
26045 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26046 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26047 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26048 else
26049 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26050 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26052 mark_cursor_off:
26053 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26054 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26058 /* EXPORT:
26059 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26060 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26061 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26063 void
26064 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
26065 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26068 int new_cursor_type;
26069 int new_cursor_width;
26070 int active_cursor;
26071 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26072 struct glyph *glyph;
26074 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26075 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26076 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26077 window. */
26078 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26079 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26080 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26081 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26082 return;
26084 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26085 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26086 return;
26088 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26089 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26090 display the cursor. */
26091 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26093 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26094 return;
26097 glyph = NULL;
26098 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26099 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26100 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26102 eassert (input_blocked_p ());
26104 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26105 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26106 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26108 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26109 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26110 erase it. */
26111 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26112 && (!on
26113 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26114 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26115 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26116 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26117 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26118 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26120 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26121 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26122 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26123 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26124 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26125 if (on)
26127 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26128 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26130 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26131 of them may need the information. */
26132 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26133 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26134 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26135 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26138 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26139 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26140 on, active_cursor);
26144 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26145 of ON. */
26147 static void
26148 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
26150 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26151 of being deleted. */
26152 if (w->current_matrix)
26154 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26155 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26156 struct glyph_row *row;
26158 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26159 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26160 return;
26162 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26164 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26165 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26166 window margin in that case. */
26167 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26168 hpos = 0;
26169 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26170 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26172 block_input ();
26173 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26174 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26175 unblock_input ();
26180 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26181 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26183 static void
26184 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
26186 while (w)
26188 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
26189 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
26190 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
26191 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
26192 else
26193 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26195 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26200 /* EXPORT:
26201 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26202 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26204 void
26205 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
26207 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26211 /* EXPORT:
26212 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26213 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26214 is about to be rewritten. */
26216 void
26217 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26219 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26220 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26223 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26225 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26226 and MSDOS. */
26227 static void
26228 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26229 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26230 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26232 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26233 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26235 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26236 return;
26238 #endif
26239 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26240 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26241 #endif
26244 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26246 static void
26247 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26249 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26250 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26252 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26253 to do anything. */
26254 w->current_matrix != NULL
26255 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26256 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26257 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26258 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26259 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26261 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26262 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26264 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26265 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26267 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26269 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26271 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26272 if (row == first)
26274 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26275 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26276 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26277 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26278 if (!row->reversed_p)
26280 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26281 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26283 else if (row == last)
26285 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26286 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26288 else
26290 start_hpos = 0;
26291 start_x = 0;
26294 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26296 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26297 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26299 else
26301 start_hpos = 0;
26302 start_x = 0;
26305 if (row == last)
26307 if (!row->reversed_p)
26308 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26309 else if (row == first)
26310 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26311 else
26313 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26314 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26315 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26318 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
26319 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26320 else
26322 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26323 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26324 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26327 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
26329 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
26330 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26332 row->mouse_face_p
26333 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
26337 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26338 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
26339 be displayed again. */
26340 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
26341 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26343 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26345 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26346 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26347 window margin in that case. */
26348 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26349 hpos = 0;
26350 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26351 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26353 block_input ();
26354 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26355 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26356 unblock_input ();
26358 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26361 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26362 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
26363 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26365 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
26366 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
26367 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
26368 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
26369 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
26370 else
26371 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
26373 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26376 /* EXPORT:
26377 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
26378 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
26379 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
26382 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
26384 int cleared = 0;
26386 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
26388 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
26389 cleared = 1;
26392 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
26393 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
26394 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
26395 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
26396 return cleared;
26399 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
26400 within the mouse face on that window. */
26401 static int
26402 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
26404 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
26406 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
26407 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26408 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
26409 return 0;
26410 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26411 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26412 return 0;
26413 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26414 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26415 return 1;
26417 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
26419 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26421 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26422 return 1;
26424 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26425 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26426 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26427 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26428 return 1;
26430 else
26432 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26434 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26435 return 1;
26437 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26438 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26439 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26440 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26441 return 1;
26443 return 0;
26447 /* EXPORT:
26448 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
26451 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
26453 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26454 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26455 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26457 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26458 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26459 margin in that case. */
26460 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26461 hpos = 0;
26462 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26463 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26465 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
26470 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
26471 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
26472 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
26473 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
26474 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
26475 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
26476 static void
26477 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
26478 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26479 Lisp_Object disp_string,
26480 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
26482 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26483 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26484 struct glyph_row *row;
26486 *start = NULL;
26487 *end = NULL;
26489 while (!first->enabled_p
26490 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
26491 first++;
26493 /* Find the START row. */
26494 for (row = first;
26495 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
26496 row++)
26498 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
26499 characters it displays intersects the range
26500 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
26501 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
26502 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
26503 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
26504 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
26505 some position is beyond the end of the characters
26506 displayed by a row. */
26507 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26508 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26509 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26510 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
26511 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26512 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26513 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26514 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
26516 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
26517 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
26518 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
26520 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
26521 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
26522 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
26523 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
26524 the range of character positions given by the row's start
26525 and end positions. */
26526 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26527 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26529 while (g < e)
26531 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26532 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26533 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26534 definition to be highlighted. */
26535 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26536 *start = row;
26537 g++;
26539 if (*start)
26540 break;
26544 /* Find the END row. */
26545 if (!*start
26546 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
26547 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
26548 && !(row->enabled_p
26549 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
26550 row = first;
26551 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
26553 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
26554 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
26556 if (!next->enabled_p
26557 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
26558 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
26559 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
26560 is the row END + 1. */
26561 || (start_charpos < next_start
26562 && end_charpos < next_start)
26563 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26564 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26565 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26566 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
26567 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26568 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26569 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26570 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
26572 *end = row;
26573 break;
26575 else
26577 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
26578 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
26579 also END + 1. */
26580 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26581 struct glyph *s = g;
26582 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
26584 while (g < e)
26586 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26587 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26588 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
26589 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
26590 the last character to be highlighted is the
26591 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
26592 END, not END+1. */
26593 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
26594 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
26595 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
26596 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
26597 empty line at ZV. */
26598 || (g->charpos == -1
26599 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26600 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
26601 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26602 definition to be highlighted. */
26603 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26604 break;
26605 g++;
26607 if (g == e)
26609 *end = row;
26610 break;
26612 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
26613 highlighted. */
26614 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
26616 *end = next;
26617 break;
26623 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
26624 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
26625 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
26626 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
26627 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
26628 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
26629 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
26630 or all of the highlighted text. */
26632 static void
26633 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
26634 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26635 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
26636 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
26637 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26638 Lisp_Object before_string,
26639 Lisp_Object after_string,
26640 Lisp_Object disp_string)
26642 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26643 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26644 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
26645 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
26646 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
26647 int x;
26649 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
26650 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
26651 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
26653 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26654 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
26655 if (r1 == NULL)
26656 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26657 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
26658 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
26659 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
26661 struct glyph_row *prev;
26662 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
26663 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
26664 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
26666 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26667 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
26668 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
26669 if (glyph < beg
26670 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
26671 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
26672 break;
26673 r1 = prev;
26676 if (r2 == NULL)
26678 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26679 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
26681 else if (!NILP (after_string))
26683 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
26684 struct glyph_row *next;
26685 struct glyph_row *last
26686 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26688 for (next = r2 + 1;
26689 next <= last
26690 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
26691 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
26692 ++next)
26693 r2 = next;
26695 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
26696 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
26697 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
26698 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
26699 them in correct order. */
26700 if (r1->y > r2->y)
26702 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
26704 r2 = r1;
26705 r1 = tem;
26708 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
26709 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
26710 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
26711 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
26713 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
26714 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
26715 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
26716 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
26717 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
26718 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
26719 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
26720 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
26721 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
26722 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
26723 if (!r1->reversed_p)
26725 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
26726 right. */
26727 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26728 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26729 x = r1->x;
26731 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26732 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26733 for (; glyph < end
26734 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26735 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26736 ++glyph)
26737 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26739 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26740 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26741 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26742 for (; glyph < end
26743 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26744 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26745 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26746 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26747 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26748 ++glyph)
26750 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26751 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26752 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26753 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26755 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
26756 start_charpos);
26757 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26758 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26759 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26760 break;
26762 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26764 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26765 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26766 break;
26768 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26770 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26771 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26773 else
26775 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
26776 left. */
26777 struct glyph *g;
26779 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26780 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26782 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26783 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26784 for (; glyph > end
26785 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26786 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26787 --glyph)
26790 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26791 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26792 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26793 for (; glyph > end
26794 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26795 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26796 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26797 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26798 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26799 --glyph)
26801 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26802 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26803 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26804 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26806 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26807 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26808 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26809 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26810 break;
26812 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26814 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26815 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26816 break;
26820 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
26821 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
26822 x += g->pixel_width;
26823 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26824 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26827 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
26828 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
26829 the row where the highlight begins. */
26830 if (r2 != r1)
26832 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26834 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26835 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26836 x = r2->x;
26838 else
26840 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26841 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26845 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26847 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26848 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26849 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26850 while (end > glyph
26851 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
26852 --end;
26853 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26854 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26855 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26856 and END_CHARPOS */
26857 for (--end;
26858 end > glyph
26859 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26860 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26861 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26862 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26863 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26864 --end)
26866 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26867 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26868 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26869 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26871 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26872 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26873 break;
26875 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26877 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26878 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26879 break;
26882 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26883 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26884 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26886 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26887 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26889 else
26891 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26892 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26893 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26894 x = r2->x;
26895 end++;
26896 while (end < glyph
26897 && INTEGERP (end->object))
26899 x += end->pixel_width;
26900 ++end;
26902 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26903 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26904 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26905 and END_CHARPOS */
26906 for ( ;
26907 end < glyph
26908 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26909 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26910 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26911 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26912 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26913 ++end)
26915 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26916 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26917 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26918 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26920 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26921 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26922 break;
26924 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26926 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26927 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26928 break;
26930 x += end->pixel_width;
26932 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
26933 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
26934 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
26935 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
26936 last glyph. */
26937 if (end == glyph
26938 && BUFFERP (end->object)
26939 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
26940 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
26942 x += end->pixel_width;
26943 ++end;
26945 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26946 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26949 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26950 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26951 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26952 mouse_charpos + 1,
26953 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26954 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26957 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26958 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26959 being, in case someone would. */
26961 #if 0 /* not used */
26963 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26964 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26965 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26967 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26968 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26970 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26971 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26972 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26973 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26974 next larger position in OBJECT.
26976 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26978 static int
26979 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
26980 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26982 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26983 struct glyph_row *r;
26984 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26985 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26986 int best_x = 0;
26988 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26989 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26990 ++r)
26992 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26993 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26994 int gx;
26996 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26997 if (EQ (g->object, object))
26999 if (g->charpos == pos)
27001 best_glyph = g;
27002 best_x = gx;
27003 best_row = r;
27004 goto found;
27006 else if (best_glyph == NULL
27007 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
27008 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
27009 && (right_p
27010 ? g->charpos < pos
27011 : g->charpos > pos)))
27013 best_glyph = g;
27014 best_x = gx;
27015 best_row = r;
27020 found:
27022 if (best_glyph)
27024 *x = best_x;
27025 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27027 if (right_p)
27029 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
27030 ++*hpos;
27033 *y = best_row->y;
27034 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
27037 return best_glyph != NULL;
27039 #endif /* not used */
27041 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
27042 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
27043 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
27044 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
27046 static void
27047 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27048 Lisp_Object object,
27049 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27051 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27052 struct glyph_row *r;
27053 struct glyph *g, *e;
27054 int gx;
27055 int found = 0;
27057 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27058 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
27059 position belongs to that range. */
27060 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27061 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27062 ++r)
27064 if (!r->reversed_p)
27066 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27067 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27068 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27069 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27070 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27072 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27073 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27074 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27075 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27076 found = 1;
27077 break;
27080 else
27082 struct glyph *g1;
27084 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27085 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27086 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27087 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27088 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27090 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27091 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27092 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27093 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27094 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27095 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27096 found = 1;
27097 break;
27100 if (found)
27101 break;
27104 if (!found)
27105 return;
27107 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27108 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27109 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27111 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27112 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27113 found = 0;
27114 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27115 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27116 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27118 found = 1;
27119 break;
27121 if (!found)
27122 break;
27125 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27126 r--;
27128 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
27129 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27130 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
27132 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27133 pixel coordinate. */
27134 if (!r->reversed_p)
27136 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27137 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27138 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27139 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27140 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27141 break;
27142 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27144 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27145 gx += g->pixel_width;
27146 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27148 else
27150 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27151 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27152 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27154 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27155 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
27156 break;
27157 gx += e->pixel_width;
27159 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27160 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27164 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27166 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27168 static int
27169 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27171 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27172 return 0;
27174 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27176 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27177 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27178 Lisp_Object tem;
27179 if (!CONSP (rect))
27180 return 0;
27181 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27182 return 0;
27183 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27184 return 0;
27185 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27186 return 0;
27187 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27188 return 0;
27189 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27190 return 0;
27191 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27192 return 0;
27193 return 1;
27195 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27197 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27198 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27199 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27200 if (CONSP (circ)
27201 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27202 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27203 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27204 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27206 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27207 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27208 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27209 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27212 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27214 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27215 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27217 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27218 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27219 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27220 ptrdiff_t i;
27221 int inside = 0;
27222 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27223 int x0, y0;
27225 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27226 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27227 return 0;
27229 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27230 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27231 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27232 polygon. */
27233 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27234 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27235 return 0;
27236 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27237 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27239 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27240 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27241 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27242 return 0;
27243 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27245 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27246 if (x0 >= x)
27248 if (x1 >= x)
27249 continue;
27251 else if (x1 < x)
27252 continue;
27253 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27254 continue;
27255 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27256 inside = !inside;
27258 return inside;
27261 return 0;
27264 Lisp_Object
27265 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27267 while (CONSP (map))
27269 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27270 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27271 return XCAR (map);
27272 map = XCDR (map);
27275 return Qnil;
27278 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27279 3, 3, 0,
27280 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27281 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27282 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27283 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27284 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27285 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27286 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27287 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27288 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27289 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27290 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27292 if (NILP (map))
27293 return Qnil;
27295 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27296 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27298 return find_hot_spot (map,
27299 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27300 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27304 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27305 static void
27306 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27308 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27309 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27310 return;
27312 if (!NILP (pointer))
27314 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
27315 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27316 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
27317 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
27318 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
27319 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27320 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
27321 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27322 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27323 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
27324 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27325 #endif
27326 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
27327 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
27328 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
27329 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
27330 else
27331 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27334 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
27335 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
27338 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27340 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
27341 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
27342 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
27343 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
27344 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
27346 static void
27347 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
27348 enum window_part area)
27350 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27351 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27352 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27353 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27354 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
27355 #endif
27356 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27357 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
27358 int dx, dy, width, height;
27359 ptrdiff_t charpos;
27360 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
27361 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
27363 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
27364 int original_x_pixel = x;
27365 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
27366 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
27368 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
27370 int x0;
27371 struct glyph *end;
27373 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27374 returns them in row/column units! */
27375 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27376 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27378 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27379 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
27380 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
27382 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
27383 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
27385 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27386 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27388 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
27389 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
27390 ++glyph)
27391 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
27393 if (glyph >= end)
27394 glyph = NULL;
27397 else
27399 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
27400 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27401 returns them in row/column units! */
27402 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27403 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27406 help = Qnil;
27408 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27409 if (IMAGEP (object))
27411 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27412 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
27413 !NILP (image_map))
27414 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
27415 CONSP (hotspot))
27416 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27418 Lisp_Object plist;
27420 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
27421 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27422 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27423 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27424 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27425 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27427 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27428 if (NILP (pointer))
27429 pointer = Qhand;
27430 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27431 if (!NILP (help))
27433 help_echo_string = help;
27434 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27435 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
27436 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27440 if (NILP (pointer))
27441 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
27443 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27445 if (STRINGP (string))
27446 pos = make_number (charpos);
27448 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
27449 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
27450 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
27451 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27453 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
27454 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
27455 if (NILP (help))
27457 if (STRINGP (string))
27458 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
27460 if (!NILP (help))
27462 help_echo_string = help;
27463 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27464 help_echo_object = string;
27465 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27467 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27469 Lisp_Object default_help
27470 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
27471 w->buffer);
27473 if (STRINGP (default_help))
27475 help_echo_string = default_help;
27476 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27477 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27478 help_echo_pos = -1;
27483 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27484 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
27485 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27487 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
27488 if (STRINGP (string))
27490 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27492 if (NILP (pointer))
27493 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
27495 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
27496 if (NILP (pointer)
27497 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
27499 Lisp_Object map;
27500 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
27501 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27502 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
27503 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27504 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27507 else
27508 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
27509 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27511 #endif
27514 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
27515 if (STRINGP (string))
27517 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
27518 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
27519 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27520 && glyph)
27522 Lisp_Object b, e;
27524 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
27526 int gpos;
27527 int gseq_length;
27528 int total_pixel_width;
27529 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
27531 int vpos, hpos;
27533 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
27534 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27535 if (NILP (b))
27536 begpos = 0;
27537 else
27538 begpos = XINT (b);
27540 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27541 if (NILP (e))
27542 endpos = SCHARS (string);
27543 else
27544 endpos = XINT (e);
27546 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
27547 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
27548 highlighted part of the string.
27550 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
27551 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
27552 line string format has structures which are converted to
27553 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
27554 internal string is an element of those structures. The
27555 displayed string is the flattened string. */
27556 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
27557 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
27558 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27559 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27560 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
27561 tmp_glyph++;
27562 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
27564 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
27565 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
27566 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
27567 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
27568 the internal string. */
27569 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27570 tmp_glyph > glyph
27571 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27572 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27573 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
27574 tmp_glyph--)
27576 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
27578 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
27579 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
27580 total_pixel_width = 0;
27581 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
27582 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
27584 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
27585 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
27586 marginal_area_string. */
27587 hpos = x - gpos;
27588 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27589 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
27590 : 0);
27592 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
27593 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
27594 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27595 && (!row->reversed_p
27596 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
27597 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27598 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
27599 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
27600 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
27601 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
27602 return;
27604 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27605 cursor = No_Cursor;
27607 if (!row->reversed_p)
27609 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
27610 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
27611 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27612 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27613 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
27615 else
27617 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
27618 coordinates to be swapped. */
27619 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
27620 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
27621 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27622 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27623 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
27626 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
27627 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
27628 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
27629 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
27630 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27631 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27633 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
27634 charpos,
27635 0, 0, 0,
27636 &ignore,
27637 glyph->face_id,
27639 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27641 if (NILP (pointer))
27642 pointer = Qhand;
27644 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27645 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27647 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27648 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27649 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27650 #endif
27654 /* EXPORT:
27655 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
27656 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
27657 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
27658 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
27660 void
27661 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
27663 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27664 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
27665 Lisp_Object window;
27666 struct window *w;
27667 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27668 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
27669 struct buffer *b;
27671 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
27672 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
27673 if (popup_activated ())
27674 return;
27675 #endif
27677 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
27678 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
27679 || f->pointer_invisible)
27680 return;
27682 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
27683 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
27684 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
27686 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
27687 return;
27689 /* Which window is that in? */
27690 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
27692 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
27693 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27694 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
27695 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27696 && !NILP (window)
27697 && part != ON_TEXT
27698 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
27699 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
27700 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27702 /* Not on a window -> return. */
27703 if (!WINDOWP (window))
27704 return;
27706 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
27707 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27709 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
27710 w = XWINDOW (window);
27711 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
27713 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27714 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
27715 buffer. */
27716 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
27718 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
27719 return;
27721 #endif
27723 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
27724 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
27725 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
27727 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
27728 return;
27731 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27732 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
27734 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27735 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
27737 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
27738 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
27739 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27740 else
27741 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27742 #endif
27744 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
27745 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
27746 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
27747 if (part == ON_TEXT
27748 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
27749 && w->last_modified == BUF_MODIFF (b)
27750 && w->last_overlay_modified == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
27752 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
27753 ptrdiff_t pos;
27754 struct glyph *glyph;
27755 Lisp_Object object;
27756 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
27757 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
27758 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
27759 struct buffer *obuf;
27760 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
27761 int same_region;
27763 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
27764 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
27766 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27767 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
27768 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
27770 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
27771 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
27773 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27774 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
27775 !NILP (image_map))
27776 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
27777 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
27778 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
27779 CONSP (hotspot))
27780 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27782 Lisp_Object plist;
27784 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
27785 this hot-spot.
27786 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27787 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27788 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27789 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27790 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27792 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27793 if (NILP (pointer))
27794 pointer = Qhand;
27795 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27796 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
27798 help_echo_window = window;
27799 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
27800 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
27804 if (NILP (pointer))
27805 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
27808 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27810 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
27811 if (glyph == NULL
27812 || area != TEXT_AREA
27813 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
27814 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
27815 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
27816 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
27817 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
27818 glyph, we are not over any text. */
27819 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27820 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
27821 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
27822 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
27823 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
27824 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
27825 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
27826 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
27827 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
27829 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27830 cursor = No_Cursor;
27831 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27832 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27834 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
27835 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27836 else
27837 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
27839 #endif
27840 goto set_cursor;
27843 pos = glyph->charpos;
27844 object = glyph->object;
27845 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
27846 goto set_cursor;
27848 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
27849 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
27850 goto set_cursor;
27852 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
27853 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
27854 obuf = current_buffer;
27855 current_buffer = b;
27856 obegv = BEGV;
27857 ozv = ZV;
27858 BEGV = BEG;
27859 ZV = Z;
27861 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
27862 position = make_number (pos);
27864 if (BUFFERP (object))
27866 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
27867 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
27868 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
27869 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
27871 else
27872 noverlays = 0;
27874 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27876 if (same_region)
27877 cursor = No_Cursor;
27879 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27880 if (! same_region
27881 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27882 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27883 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27884 highlight only that. */
27885 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27886 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27888 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27889 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27890 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27892 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27893 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27894 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27897 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27898 no need to do that again. */
27899 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27900 goto check_help_echo;
27901 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27903 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27904 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27905 cursor = No_Cursor;
27907 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27908 if (NILP (overlay))
27909 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27911 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27912 display it. */
27913 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27915 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27916 with a mouse-face. */
27917 Lisp_Object s, e;
27918 ptrdiff_t ignore;
27920 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27921 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27922 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27923 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27924 if (NILP (s))
27925 s = make_number (0);
27926 if (NILP (e))
27927 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27928 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27929 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27930 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27931 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27932 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27933 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27934 glyph->face_id, 1);
27935 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27936 cursor = No_Cursor;
27938 else
27940 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27941 or text property in the buffer. */
27942 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27943 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27945 if (STRINGP (object))
27947 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27948 check if the text under it has one. */
27949 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27950 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27951 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27952 if (pos > 0)
27954 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27955 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27956 buffer = w->buffer;
27957 disp_string = object;
27960 else
27962 buffer = object;
27963 disp_string = Qnil;
27966 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27968 Lisp_Object before, after;
27969 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27970 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27971 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27972 optimization of limiting the search in
27973 previous-single-property-change and
27974 next-single-property-change, because
27975 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27976 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27977 the first row visible in a window does not
27978 necessarily display the character whose position
27979 is the smallest. */
27980 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27981 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27982 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
27983 : Qnil;
27984 Lisp_Object lim2 =
27985 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27986 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27987 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
27988 : Qnil;
27990 if (NILP (overlay))
27992 /* Handle the text property case. */
27993 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
27994 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
27995 after = Fnext_single_property_change
27996 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
27997 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
27999 else
28001 /* Handle the overlay case. */
28002 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
28003 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
28004 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
28005 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
28007 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
28008 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
28011 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
28012 NILP (before)
28014 : XFASTINT (before),
28015 NILP (after)
28016 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
28017 : XFASTINT (after),
28018 before_string, after_string,
28019 disp_string);
28020 cursor = No_Cursor;
28025 check_help_echo:
28027 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
28028 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
28029 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
28031 /* Check overlays first. */
28032 help = overlay = Qnil;
28033 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
28035 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
28036 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
28039 if (!NILP (help))
28041 help_echo_string = help;
28042 help_echo_window = window;
28043 help_echo_object = overlay;
28044 help_echo_pos = pos;
28046 else
28048 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28049 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28051 /* Try text properties. */
28052 if (STRINGP (obj)
28053 && charpos >= 0
28054 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28056 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28057 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28058 if (NILP (help))
28060 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28061 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28062 struct glyph_row *r
28063 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28064 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28065 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28066 if (p > 0)
28068 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28069 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
28070 if (!NILP (help))
28072 charpos = p;
28073 obj = w->buffer;
28078 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28079 && charpos >= BEGV
28080 && charpos < ZV)
28081 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28082 obj);
28084 if (!NILP (help))
28086 help_echo_string = help;
28087 help_echo_window = window;
28088 help_echo_object = obj;
28089 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28094 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28095 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28096 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28098 /* Check overlays first. */
28099 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28100 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28102 if (NILP (pointer))
28104 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28105 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28107 /* Try text properties. */
28108 if (STRINGP (obj)
28109 && charpos >= 0
28110 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28112 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28113 Qpointer, obj);
28114 if (NILP (pointer))
28116 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28117 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28118 struct glyph_row *r
28119 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28120 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28121 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28122 if (p > 0)
28123 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28124 Qpointer, w->buffer);
28127 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28128 && charpos >= BEGV
28129 && charpos < ZV)
28130 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28131 Qpointer, obj);
28134 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28136 BEGV = obegv;
28137 ZV = ozv;
28138 current_buffer = obuf;
28141 set_cursor:
28143 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28144 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28145 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28146 #else
28147 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28148 compound statement". */
28149 return;
28150 #endif
28154 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28155 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28156 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28157 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28159 void
28160 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28162 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28163 Lisp_Object window;
28165 block_input ();
28166 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28167 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28168 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28169 unblock_input ();
28173 /* EXPORT:
28174 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28175 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28177 void
28178 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28180 Lisp_Object window;
28181 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28183 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28184 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28186 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
28187 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
28188 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
28194 /***********************************************************************
28195 Exposure Events
28196 ***********************************************************************/
28198 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28200 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28201 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28203 static void
28204 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28205 enum glyph_row_area area)
28207 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28208 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28209 struct glyph *last;
28210 int first_x, start_x, x;
28212 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28213 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28214 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28215 0, row->used[area],
28216 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28217 else
28219 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28220 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28221 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28222 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28223 x = start_x;
28224 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28225 x += row->x;
28227 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28228 while (first < end
28229 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28231 x += first->pixel_width;
28232 ++first;
28235 /* Find the last one. */
28236 last = first;
28237 first_x = x;
28238 while (last < end
28239 && x < r->x + r->width)
28241 x += last->pixel_width;
28242 ++last;
28245 /* Repaint. */
28246 if (last > first)
28247 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28248 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28249 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28254 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28255 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28256 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28258 static int
28259 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28261 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28263 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28264 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28265 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28266 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28267 else
28269 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28270 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28271 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28272 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28273 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28274 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28275 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28278 return row->mouse_face_p;
28282 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28283 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28284 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28286 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28287 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28288 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28290 static void
28291 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28292 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28293 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28294 XRectangle *r)
28296 struct glyph_row *row;
28298 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28299 if (row->overlapping_p)
28301 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
28303 row->clip = r;
28304 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28305 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28307 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28308 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28310 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28311 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28312 row->clip = NULL;
28317 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
28319 static int
28320 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28322 XRectangle cr, result;
28323 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
28324 struct glyph_row *row;
28326 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
28327 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
28328 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
28329 row->enabled_p)
28330 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
28332 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
28333 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
28334 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
28335 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
28336 : TEXT_AREA));
28337 cr.y = row->y;
28338 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
28339 cr.height = row->height;
28340 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28343 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
28344 if (cursor_glyph)
28346 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
28347 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
28348 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
28349 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
28350 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
28351 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
28352 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
28353 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
28354 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28356 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
28357 return 0;
28361 /* EXPORT:
28362 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
28363 have vertical scroll bars. */
28365 void
28366 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
28368 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
28370 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
28371 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
28372 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
28374 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
28375 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
28376 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
28377 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
28378 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
28379 return;
28381 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
28382 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
28384 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28386 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28387 y1 -= 1;
28389 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28390 x1 -= 1;
28392 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
28394 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
28395 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
28397 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28399 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28400 y1 -= 1;
28402 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28403 x0 -= 1;
28405 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
28410 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
28411 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
28412 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
28413 mouse-face. */
28415 static int
28416 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
28418 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28419 XRectangle wr, r;
28420 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28422 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
28423 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
28424 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
28425 created window. */
28426 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
28427 return 0;
28429 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
28430 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
28431 later. */
28432 if (w == updated_window)
28434 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
28435 return 0;
28438 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
28439 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28440 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28441 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
28442 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
28444 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
28446 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
28447 struct glyph_row *row;
28448 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
28449 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
28451 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
28452 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28454 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
28455 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28456 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28458 /* Turn off the cursor. */
28459 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
28460 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
28462 x_clear_cursor (w);
28463 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
28465 else
28466 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
28468 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
28469 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
28470 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
28471 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
28472 check later if it is changed. */
28473 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
28475 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
28476 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
28477 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
28478 row->enabled_p;
28479 ++row)
28481 int y0 = row->y;
28482 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
28484 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
28485 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
28486 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
28487 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
28489 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
28490 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
28491 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
28493 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28494 first_overlapping_row = row;
28495 last_overlapping_row = row;
28498 row->clip = fr;
28499 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28500 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28501 row->clip = NULL;
28503 else if (row->overlapping_p)
28505 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
28506 if (y0 < r.y
28507 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
28508 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
28510 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28511 first_overlapping_row = row;
28512 last_overlapping_row = row;
28516 if (y1 >= yb)
28517 break;
28520 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
28521 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
28522 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
28523 row->enabled_p)
28524 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
28526 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28527 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28530 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
28532 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
28533 if (first_overlapping_row)
28534 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
28535 fr);
28537 /* Draw border between windows. */
28538 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
28540 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
28541 if (cursor_cleared_p
28542 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
28543 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
28547 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28552 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
28553 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
28554 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
28556 static int
28557 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28559 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28560 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28562 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28564 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
28565 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28566 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
28567 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
28568 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28569 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
28570 else
28571 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
28573 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
28576 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28580 /* EXPORT:
28581 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
28582 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
28583 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
28584 the entire frame. */
28586 void
28587 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
28589 XRectangle r;
28590 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28592 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
28594 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
28595 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28597 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
28598 return;
28601 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
28602 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
28603 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
28604 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
28605 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
28607 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
28608 return;
28611 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
28613 r.x = r.y = 0;
28614 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
28615 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
28617 else
28619 r.x = x;
28620 r.y = y;
28621 r.width = w;
28622 r.height = h;
28625 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28626 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
28628 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
28629 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28630 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
28632 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28633 #ifndef MSDOS
28634 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
28635 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
28636 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28637 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
28638 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
28639 #endif
28640 #endif
28642 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
28643 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
28644 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
28645 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
28646 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
28647 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
28648 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
28649 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
28650 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
28651 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
28652 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
28653 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
28654 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
28655 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28657 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28658 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
28660 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
28661 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
28662 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28663 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
28669 /* EXPORT:
28670 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
28671 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
28672 empty. */
28675 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
28677 XRectangle *left, *right;
28678 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
28679 int intersection_p = 0;
28681 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
28682 if (r1->x < r2->x)
28683 left = r1, right = r2;
28684 else
28685 left = r2, right = r1;
28687 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
28688 otherwise there is no intersection. */
28689 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
28691 result->x = right->x;
28693 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
28694 the right ends of left and right. */
28695 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
28696 - result->x);
28698 /* Same game for Y. */
28699 if (r1->y < r2->y)
28700 upper = r1, lower = r2;
28701 else
28702 upper = r2, lower = r1;
28704 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
28705 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
28706 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
28708 result->y = lower->y;
28710 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
28711 ends of upper and lower. */
28712 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
28713 upper->y + upper->height)
28714 - result->y);
28715 intersection_p = 1;
28719 return intersection_p;
28722 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28725 /***********************************************************************
28726 Initialization
28727 ***********************************************************************/
28729 void
28730 syms_of_xdisp (void)
28732 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
28733 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
28735 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
28736 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
28738 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
28739 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_internal, "redisplay_internal (C function)");
28741 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
28742 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
28743 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
28744 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
28745 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
28746 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
28748 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28749 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
28750 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
28751 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
28752 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
28753 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
28754 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
28755 #endif
28756 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28757 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
28758 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
28759 #endif
28760 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
28761 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
28762 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
28764 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
28765 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
28766 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
28767 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
28768 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
28769 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
28770 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
28771 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
28772 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
28773 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
28774 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
28775 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
28776 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
28777 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
28778 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
28779 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
28780 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
28781 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
28782 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
28783 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
28784 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
28785 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
28786 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
28787 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
28788 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
28789 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
28790 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
28791 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
28792 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
28793 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
28794 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
28795 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
28796 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
28797 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
28798 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
28799 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
28800 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
28801 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
28802 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
28803 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
28804 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
28805 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
28806 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
28807 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
28808 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
28809 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
28810 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
28811 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
28812 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
28813 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
28814 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
28815 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
28816 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
28817 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
28818 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
28820 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
28821 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
28822 Qnil);
28823 staticpro (&list_of_error);
28825 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
28826 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
28827 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
28828 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
28830 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28831 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
28832 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
28834 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28835 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
28836 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
28838 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
28839 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
28841 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
28842 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
28843 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
28844 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
28845 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
28846 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
28847 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
28848 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
28849 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
28850 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
28852 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
28854 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28855 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
28856 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28857 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
28858 help_echo_window = Qnil;
28859 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
28860 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
28861 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
28862 help_echo_pos = -1;
28864 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
28865 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
28867 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28868 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
28869 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
28870 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
28871 wide as that tab on the display. */);
28872 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
28873 #endif
28875 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
28876 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
28877 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
28878 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
28880 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
28881 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
28882 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
28883 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
28884 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
28886 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
28887 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
28889 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
28890 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
28892 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
28893 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28895 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28896 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28897 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28898 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28899 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28901 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28902 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28903 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28904 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28906 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28907 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28908 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28910 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28911 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28912 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28913 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28914 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28916 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28917 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28918 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28919 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
28921 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28922 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28923 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28924 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28925 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28926 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28928 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28929 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28930 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28931 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28932 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28933 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28935 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28936 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28937 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28938 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28939 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28940 recenters point as usual.
28942 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28943 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28944 if you move far away.
28946 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28947 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28949 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28950 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28951 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28952 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28953 scroll_margin = 0;
28955 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28956 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28957 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28958 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28960 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28961 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28962 #endif
28964 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28965 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28966 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28967 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28968 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28969 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28971 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28972 not span the full frame width.
28974 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28976 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28977 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28979 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28980 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28981 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
28982 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
28983 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
28985 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
28986 line_number_display_limit_width,
28987 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
28988 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
28989 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
28990 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
28992 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
28993 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
28994 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
28996 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
28997 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
28998 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
28999 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
29000 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
29002 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
29003 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
29004 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29006 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
29007 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
29008 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29010 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
29011 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
29012 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
29013 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
29014 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
29015 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
29016 Vicon_title_format
29017 = Vframe_title_format
29018 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
29019 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
29020 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
29021 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
29022 empty_unibyte_string,
29023 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
29024 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
29025 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
29027 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
29028 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
29029 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
29030 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
29031 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (1000);
29033 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
29034 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29035 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29036 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29037 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29038 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29039 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29041 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29042 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29043 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29044 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29045 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29046 valid when these functions are called.
29048 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29049 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29050 work. */);
29051 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29053 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29054 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29055 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29056 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29058 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29059 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29060 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29061 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29062 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29064 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29065 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29066 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29067 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29068 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29069 window for the duration of the delay.
29070 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29071 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29072 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29073 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29074 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29075 mouse pointer enters it.
29077 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29078 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29080 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29081 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29082 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29084 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29085 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29086 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29087 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29088 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29089 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29090 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29092 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29093 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29094 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29096 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29097 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29098 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29100 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29101 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29102 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29103 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29104 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29105 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29106 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29108 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29109 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29110 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29111 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29112 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29113 vertical margin. */);
29114 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29116 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29117 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29118 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29120 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29121 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29122 It can be one of
29123 image - show images only
29124 text - show text only
29125 both - show both, text below image
29126 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29127 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29128 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29130 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29131 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29133 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29134 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29135 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29136 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29137 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29139 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29140 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29141 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29142 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29143 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29144 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29145 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29147 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29148 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29149 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29150 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29151 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29152 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29153 displayed according to the current fontset.
29155 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29156 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29157 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29159 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29160 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29161 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29162 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29163 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29165 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29166 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29167 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29168 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29169 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29170 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29171 echo area becomes empty. */);
29172 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29174 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29175 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29176 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29177 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29178 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29179 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29180 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29182 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29183 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29184 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29186 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29187 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29188 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29189 point visible. */);
29190 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29191 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29193 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29194 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29195 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29196 hscroll_margin = 5;
29198 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29199 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29200 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29201 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29202 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29203 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29204 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29205 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29206 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29208 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29209 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29210 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29212 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29213 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29214 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29216 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29217 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29218 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29219 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29221 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29222 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29223 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29224 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29225 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29226 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29228 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29229 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29230 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29231 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29233 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29234 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29235 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29237 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29238 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29239 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29240 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29242 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29243 property.
29245 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29246 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29247 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29248 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29250 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29251 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29252 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29253 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29255 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
29256 property.
29258 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
29259 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
29260 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
29261 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
29263 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
29264 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
29265 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
29267 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
29268 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
29269 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
29271 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29272 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
29273 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
29274 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
29276 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
29277 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
29278 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
29280 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
29281 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
29282 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
29283 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
29285 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
29286 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
29287 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
29288 margin to the character height. */);
29289 overline_margin = 2;
29291 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
29292 underline_minimum_offset,
29293 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
29294 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
29295 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
29296 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
29297 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
29298 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
29300 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
29301 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
29302 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
29303 cursor shapes. */);
29304 display_hourglass_p = 1;
29306 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
29307 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
29308 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
29310 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29311 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
29313 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
29314 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
29315 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
29316 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
29317 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
29319 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
29320 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
29321 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
29322 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
29323 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
29324 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
29326 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
29327 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
29328 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
29329 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
29330 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
29331 `empty-box': display as an empty box
29332 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
29333 `zero-width': don't display
29334 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
29335 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
29336 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
29338 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
29339 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
29340 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
29341 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
29342 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
29343 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
29344 Qempty_box);
29346 DEFVAR_LISP ("debug-on-message", Vdebug_on_message,
29347 doc: /* If non-nil, debug if a message matching this regexp is displayed. */);
29348 Vdebug_on_message = Qnil;
29352 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
29354 void
29355 init_xdisp (void)
29357 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
29359 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
29361 if (!noninteractive)
29363 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
29364 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
29365 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
29366 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
29367 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
29368 int i;
29370 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
29372 wset_top_line (r, make_number (FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29373 wset_total_lines
29374 (r, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29375 wset_total_cols (r, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29376 wset_top_line (m, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1));
29377 wset_total_lines (m, make_number (1));
29378 wset_total_cols (m, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29380 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
29381 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
29382 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
29384 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
29385 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
29386 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
29390 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
29391 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
29392 int size = 100;
29393 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
29394 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
29395 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
29396 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
29399 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
29402 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
29404 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
29405 void
29406 start_hourglass (void)
29408 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29409 EMACS_TIME delay;
29411 cancel_hourglass ();
29413 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
29414 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29415 delay = make_emacs_time (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
29416 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
29418 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
29419 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29420 delay = EMACS_TIME_FROM_DOUBLE (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
29421 else
29422 delay = make_emacs_time (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
29424 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
29426 extern void w32_note_current_window (void);
29427 w32_note_current_window ();
29429 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */
29431 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
29432 show_hourglass, NULL);
29433 #endif
29437 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
29438 shown. */
29439 void
29440 cancel_hourglass (void)
29442 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29443 if (hourglass_atimer)
29445 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
29446 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29449 if (hourglass_shown_p)
29450 hide_hourglass ();
29451 #endif